* gdb.texinfo: Document new 'set step-mode' command.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988-2000
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c
5 @c %**start of header
6 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8 @setfilename gdb.info
9 @c
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c
12 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
13 @setchapternewpage odd
14 @c %**end of header
15
16 @iftex
17 @c @smallbook
18 @c @cropmarks
19 @end iftex
20
21 @finalout
22 @syncodeindex ky cp
23
24 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
25 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
26 @syncodeindex vr cp
27 @syncodeindex fn cp
28
29 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
30 @set EDITION Eighth
31
32 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
33 @set DATE March 2000
34
35 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
36
37 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
38 @c manuals to an info tree.
39 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
40 @direntry
41 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
42 @end direntry
43
44 @ifinfo
45 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
46
47
48 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
49 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
50 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
51
52 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
53
54 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
55 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
56 are preserved on all copies.
57
58 @ignore
59 Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
60 results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
61 notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
62 (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
63
64 @end ignore
65 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
66 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
67 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
68 permission notice identical to this one.
69
70 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
71 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
72 @end ifinfo
73
74 @titlepage
75 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
76 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
77 @sp 1
78 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
79 @subtitle @value{DATE}
80 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
81 @page
82 @tex
83 {\parskip=0pt
84 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
85 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
86 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
87 }
88 @end tex
89
90 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
91 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
92 @sp 2
93 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
94 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
95 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
96 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
97
98 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
99 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
100 are preserved on all copies.
101
102 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
103 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
104 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
105 permission notice identical to this one.
106
107 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
108 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifinfo
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 @menu
125 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
126 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
127
128 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
129 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
130 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
131 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
132 * Stack:: Examining the stack
133 * Source:: Examining source files
134 * Data:: Examining data
135
136 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
137
138 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
139 * Altering:: Altering execution
140 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
141 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
142 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
147 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
148
149 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
155 * Index:: Index
156 @end menu
157
158 @end ifinfo
159
160 @c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
161
162 @ifhtml
163 @node Top
164
165 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
166
167 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
168
169 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
170 @value{GDBVN}.
171
172 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
173
174 @menu
175 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
176 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
177
178 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
179 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
180 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
181 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
182 * Stack:: Examining the stack
183 * Source:: Examining source files
184 * Data:: Examining data
185
186 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
187
188 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
189 * Altering:: Altering execution
190 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
191 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
192 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
193 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
194 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
195 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
196 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
197
198 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
199 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
200
201 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
202 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
203 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
204 * Index:: Index
205 @end menu
206
207 @end ifhtml
208
209 @c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
210 @iftex
211 @contents
212 @end iftex
213
214 @node Summary
215 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
216
217 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
218 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
219 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
220
221 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
222 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
223
224 @itemize @bullet
225 @item
226 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
227
228 @item
229 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
230
231 @item
232 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
233
234 @item
235 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
236 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
237 @end itemize
238
239 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
240 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
241 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
242
243 @cindex Chill
244 @cindex Modula-2
245 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
246 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
247
248 @cindex Pascal
249 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
250 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
251 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
252 syntax.
253
254 @cindex Fortran
255 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
256 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
257 underscore.
258
259 @menu
260 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
261 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
262 @end menu
263
264 @node Free Software
265 @unnumberedsec Free software
266
267 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
268 General Public License
269 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
270 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
271 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
272 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
273 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
274 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
275
276 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
277 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
278 from anyone else.
279
280 @node Contributors
281 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
282
283 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
284 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
285 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
286 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
287 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
288 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
289 blow-by-blow account.
290
291 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
292
293 @quotation
294 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
295 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
296 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
297 @end quotation
298
299 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
300 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
301 releases:
302 Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
303 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
304 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
305 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
306 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
307 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
308 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
309 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
310 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
311
312 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
313 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
314
315 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
316 @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
317 Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
318 C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
319 to release 3.0).
320
321 @value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
322 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
323 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
324
325 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
326 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
327
328 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
329
330 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
331 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
332 support.
333 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
334 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
335 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
336 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
337 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
338 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
339 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
340 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
341 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
342 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
343 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
344 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
345 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
346 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
347 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
348
349 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
350
351 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
352 libraries.
353
354 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
355 about several machine instruction sets.
356
357 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
358 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
359 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
360 and RDI targets, respectively.
361
362 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
363 command-line editing and command history.
364
365 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
366 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
367
368 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
369 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
370 symbols.
371
372 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
373 Super-H processors.
374
375 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
376
377 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
378
379 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
380
381 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
382
383 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
384
385 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
386 watchpoints.
387
388 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
389
390 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
391
392 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
393 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
394
395 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
396 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
397 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
398 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
399 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
400 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
401 information in this manual.
402
403 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
404 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
405 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
406 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
407 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
408 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
409 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
410 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
411 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
412 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
413 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
414 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
415 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
416 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
417 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
418
419
420 @node Sample Session
421 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
422
423 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
424 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
425 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
426
427 @iftex
428 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
429 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
430 @end iftex
431
432 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
433 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
434
435 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
436 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
437 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
438 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
439 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
440 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
441 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
442 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
443 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
444
445 @smallexample
446 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
447 $ @b{./m4}
448 @b{define(foo,0000)}
449
450 @b{foo}
451 0000
452 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
453
454 @b{bar}
455 0000
456 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
457
458 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
459 @b{baz}
460 @b{C-d}
461 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
462 @end smallexample
463
464 @noindent
465 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
466
467 @smallexample
468 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
469 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
470 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
471 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
472 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
473 the conditions.
474 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
475 for details.
476
477 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
478 (@value{GDBP})
479 @end smallexample
480
481 @noindent
482 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
483 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
484 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
485 that examples fit in this manual.
486
487 @smallexample
488 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
489 @end smallexample
490
491 @noindent
492 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
493 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
494 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
495 @code{break} command.
496
497 @smallexample
498 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
499 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
500 @end smallexample
501
502 @noindent
503 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
504 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
505 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
506
507 @smallexample
508 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
509 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
510 @b{define(foo,0000)}
511
512 @b{foo}
513 0000
514 @end smallexample
515
516 @noindent
517 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
518 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
519 context where it stops.
520
521 @smallexample
522 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
523
524 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
525 at builtin.c:879
526 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
527 @end smallexample
528
529 @noindent
530 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
531 the next line of the current function.
532
533 @smallexample
534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
535 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
536 : nil,
537 @end smallexample
538
539 @noindent
540 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
541 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
542 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
543 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
544
545 @smallexample
546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
547 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
548 at input.c:530
549 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
550 @end smallexample
551
552 @noindent
553 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
554 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
555 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
556 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
557 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
558 stack frame for each active subroutine.
559
560 @smallexample
561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
562 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
563 at input.c:530
564 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
565 at builtin.c:882
566 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
567 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
568 at macro.c:71
569 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
570 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
571 @end smallexample
572
573 @noindent
574 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
575 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
576 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
577
578 @smallexample
579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
580 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
582 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
583 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
585 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
586 : xstrdup(rq);
587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
588 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
589 @end smallexample
590
591 @noindent
592 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
593 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
594 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
595 (@code{print}) to see their values.
596
597 @smallexample
598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
599 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
601 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
606 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
607 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
608
609 @smallexample
610 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
611 533 xfree(rquote);
612 534
613 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
614 : xstrdup (lq);
615 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
616 : xstrdup (rq);
617 537
618 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
619 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
620 540 @}
621 541
622 542 void
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
627 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633 540 @}
634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
635 $3 = 9
636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
637 $4 = 7
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
642 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
643 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
644 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
645 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
646 assignments.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
650 $5 = 7
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
652 $6 = 9
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
657 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
658 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
659 example that caused trouble initially:
660
661 @smallexample
662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
663 Continuing.
664
665 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
666
667 baz
668 0000
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
673 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
674 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
675
676 @smallexample
677 @b{C-d}
678 Program exited normally.
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
683 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
684 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
685
686 @smallexample
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
688 @end smallexample
689
690 @node Invocation
691 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
692
693 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
694 The essentials are:
695 @itemize @bullet
696 @item
697 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
698 @item
699 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
700 @end itemize
701
702 @menu
703 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
704 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
705 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
706 @end menu
707
708 @node Invoking GDB
709 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
710
711 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
712 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
713
714 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
715 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
716
717 The command-line options described here are designed
718 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
719 options may effectively be unavailable.
720
721 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
722 specifying an executable program:
723
724 @example
725 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
726 @end example
727
728 @noindent
729 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
730 specified:
731
732 @example
733 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
734 @end example
735
736 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
737 to debug a running process:
738
739 @example
740 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
741 @end example
742
743 @noindent
744 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
745 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
746
747 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
748 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
749 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
750 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
751 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
752
753 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
754 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
755
756 @smallexample
757 @value{GDBP} -silent
758 @end smallexample
759
760 @noindent
761 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
762 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
763
764 @noindent
765 Type
766
767 @example
768 @value{GDBP} -help
769 @end example
770
771 @noindent
772 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
773 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
774
775 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
776 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
777 @samp{-x} option is used.
778
779
780 @menu
781 * File Options:: Choosing files
782 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
783 @end menu
784
785 @node File Options
786 @subsection Choosing files
787
788 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
789 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
790 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
791 @samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
792 that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
793 @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
794 that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
795 the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
796
797 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
798 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
799 argument and ignore it.
800
801 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
802 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
803 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
804 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
805 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
806
807 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
808 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
809 @c it.
810
811 @table @code
812 @item -symbols @var{file}
813 @itemx -s @var{file}
814 @cindex @code{--symbols}
815 @cindex @code{-s}
816 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
817
818 @item -exec @var{file}
819 @itemx -e @var{file}
820 @cindex @code{--exec}
821 @cindex @code{-e}
822 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
823 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
824
825 @item -se @var{file}
826 @cindex @code{--se}
827 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
828 file.
829
830 @item -core @var{file}
831 @itemx -c @var{file}
832 @cindex @code{--core}
833 @cindex @code{-c}
834 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
835
836 @item -c @var{number}
837 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
838 (unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
839 case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
840
841 @item -command @var{file}
842 @itemx -x @var{file}
843 @cindex @code{--command}
844 @cindex @code{-x}
845 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
846 Files,, Command files}.
847
848 @item -directory @var{directory}
849 @itemx -d @var{directory}
850 @cindex @code{--directory}
851 @cindex @code{-d}
852 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
853
854 @item -m
855 @itemx -mapped
856 @cindex @code{--mapped}
857 @cindex @code{-m}
858 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
859 supported on all systems.}@*
860 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
861 system call, you can use this option
862 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
863 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
864 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
865 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
866 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
867 the symbol table from the executable program.
868
869 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
870 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
871 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
872
873 @item -r
874 @itemx -readnow
875 @cindex @code{--readnow}
876 @cindex @code{-r}
877 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
878 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
879 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
880
881 @end table
882
883 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
884 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
885 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
886 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
887 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
888
889 @example
890 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
891 @end example
892
893 @node Mode Options
894 @subsection Choosing modes
895
896 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
897 batch mode or quiet mode.
898
899 @table @code
900 @item -nx
901 @itemx -n
902 @cindex @code{--nx}
903 @cindex @code{-n}
904 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
905 called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
906 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
907 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
908 files}.
909
910 @item -quiet
911 @itemx -silent
912 @itemx -q
913 @cindex @code{--quiet}
914 @cindex @code{--silent}
915 @cindex @code{-q}
916 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
917 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
918
919 @item -batch
920 @cindex @code{--batch}
921 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
922 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
923 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
924 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
925 in the command files.
926
927 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
928 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
929 make this more useful, the message
930
931 @example
932 Program exited normally.
933 @end example
934
935 @noindent
936 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
937 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
938 mode.
939
940 @item -nowindows
941 @itemx -nw
942 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
943 @cindex @code{-nw}
944 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
945 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
946 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
947
948 @item -windows
949 @itemx -w
950 @cindex @code{--windows}
951 @cindex @code{-w}
952 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
953 used if possible.
954
955 @item -cd @var{directory}
956 @cindex @code{--cd}
957 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
958 instead of the current directory.
959
960 @item -fullname
961 @itemx -f
962 @cindex @code{--fullname}
963 @cindex @code{-f}
964 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
965 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
966 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
967 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
968 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
969 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
970 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
971 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
972 frame.
973
974 @item -epoch
975 @cindex @code{--epoch}
976 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
977 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
978 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
979 separate window.
980
981 @item -annotate @var{level}
982 @cindex @code{--annotate}
983 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
984 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
985 (@pxref{Annotations}).
986 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
987 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
988 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
989 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
990 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
991
992 @item -async
993 @cindex @code{--async}
994 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
995 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
996 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
997 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
998 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
999 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1000 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1001 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1002 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
1003 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1004 yet.)
1005 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1006 @c should be removed.
1007
1008 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1009 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1010 @samp{-noasync} option.
1011
1012 @item -noasync
1013 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1014 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1015
1016 @item -baud @var{bps}
1017 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1018 @cindex @code{--baud}
1019 @cindex @code{-b}
1020 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1021 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1022
1023 @item -tty @var{device}
1024 @itemx -t @var{device}
1025 @cindex @code{--tty}
1026 @cindex @code{-t}
1027 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1028 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1029
1030 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1031 @c @item -tui
1032 @c @cindex @code{--tui}
1033 @c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1034 @c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1035 @c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1036 @c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1037 @c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1038
1039 @c @item -xdb
1040 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1041 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1042 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1043 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1044 @c systems.
1045
1046 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1047 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1048 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1049 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1050 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1051 @samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
1052 interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
1053
1054 @item -write
1055 @cindex @code{--write}
1056 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1057 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1058 (@pxref{Patching}).
1059
1060 @item -statistics
1061 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1062 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1063 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1064
1065 @item -version
1066 @cindex @code{--version}
1067 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1068 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1069
1070 @end table
1071
1072 @node Quitting GDB
1073 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1074 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1075 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1076
1077 @table @code
1078 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1080 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1081 @itemx q
1082 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1083 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1084 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1085 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1086 error code.
1087 @end table
1088
1089 @cindex interrupt
1090 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1091 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1092 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1093 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1094 until a time when it is safe.
1095
1096 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1097 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1098 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1099
1100 @node Shell Commands
1101 @section Shell commands
1102
1103 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1104 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1105 just use the @code{shell} command.
1106
1107 @table @code
1108 @kindex shell
1109 @cindex shell escape
1110 @item shell @var{command string}
1111 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1112 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1113 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1114 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1115 @end table
1116
1117 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1118 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1119 @value{GDBN}:
1120
1121 @table @code
1122 @kindex make
1123 @cindex calling make
1124 @item make @var{make-args}
1125 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1126 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1127 @end table
1128
1129 @node Commands
1130 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1131
1132 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1133 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1134 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1135 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1136 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1137
1138 @menu
1139 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1140 * Completion:: Command completion
1141 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1142 @end menu
1143
1144 @node Command Syntax
1145 @section Command syntax
1146
1147 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1148 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1149 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1150 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1151 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1152 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1153
1154 @cindex abbreviation
1155 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1156 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1157 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1158 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1159 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1160 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1161 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1162
1163 @cindex repeating commands
1164 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1165 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1166 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1167 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1168 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1169 repeat.
1170
1171 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1172 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1173 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1174
1175 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1176 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1177 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1178 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1179 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1180
1181 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1182 @cindex comment
1183 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1184 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1185 Files,,Command files}).
1186
1187 @node Completion
1188 @section Command completion
1189
1190 @cindex completion
1191 @cindex word completion
1192 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1193 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1194 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1195 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1196
1197 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1198 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1199 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1200 enter it). For example, if you type
1201
1202 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1203 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1204 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1205 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1206 @example
1207 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1208 @end example
1209
1210 @noindent
1211 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1212 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1213
1214 @example
1215 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1216 @end example
1217
1218 @noindent
1219 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1220 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1221 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1222 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1223 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1224 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1225
1226 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1227 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1228 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1229 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1230 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1231 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1232 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1233 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1234 example:
1235
1236 @example
1237 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1238 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1239 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1240 make_abs_section make_function_type
1241 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1242 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1243 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1244 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1245 @end example
1246
1247 @noindent
1248 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1249 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1250 command.
1251
1252 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1253 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1254 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1255 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1256 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1257
1258 @cindex quotes in commands
1259 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1260 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1261 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1262 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1263 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1264 @value{GDBN} commands.
1265
1266 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1267 name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1268 (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1269 type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1270 distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1271 @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1272 @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1273 facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1274 beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1275 consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1276 @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1277
1278 @example
1279 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1280 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1281 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1282 @end example
1283
1284 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1285 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1286 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1287 place:
1288
1289 @example
1290 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1291 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1292 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1293 @end example
1294
1295 @noindent
1296 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1297 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1298 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1299
1300 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1301 expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1302 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1303 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
1304
1305
1306 @node Help
1307 @section Getting help
1308 @cindex online documentation
1309 @kindex help
1310
1311 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1312 using the command @code{help}.
1313
1314 @table @code
1315 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1316 @item help
1317 @itemx h
1318 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1319 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1320
1321 @smallexample
1322 (@value{GDBP}) help
1323 List of classes of commands:
1324
1325 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1326 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1327 data -- Examining data
1328 files -- Specifying and examining files
1329 internals -- Maintenance commands
1330 obscure -- Obscure features
1331 running -- Running the program
1332 stack -- Examining the stack
1333 status -- Status inquiries
1334 support -- Support facilities
1335 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1336 stopping the program
1337 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1338
1339 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1340 commands in that class.
1341 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1342 documentation.
1343 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1344 (@value{GDBP})
1345 @end smallexample
1346 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1347
1348 @item help @var{class}
1349 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1350 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1351 help display for the class @code{status}:
1352
1353 @smallexample
1354 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1355 Status inquiries.
1356
1357 List of commands:
1358
1359 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1360 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1361 info -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the program being debugged
1363 show -- Generic command for showing things
1364 about the debugger
1365
1366 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1367 documentation.
1368 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1369 (@value{GDBP})
1370 @end smallexample
1371
1372 @item help @var{command}
1373 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1374 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1375
1376 @kindex apropos
1377 @item apropos @var{args}
1378 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1379 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1380 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1381
1382 @smallexample
1383 apropos reload
1384 @end smallexample
1385
1386 @noindent results in:
1387
1388 @smallexample
1389 @c @group
1390 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1391 multiple times in one run
1392 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1393 multiple times in one run
1394 @c @end group
1395 @end smallexample
1396
1397 @kindex complete
1398 @item complete @var{args}
1399 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1400 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1401 command you want completed. For example:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 complete i
1405 @end smallexample
1406
1407 @noindent results in:
1408
1409 @smallexample
1410 @group
1411 if
1412 ignore
1413 info
1414 inspect
1415 @end group
1416 @end smallexample
1417
1418 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1419 @end table
1420
1421 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1422 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1423 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1424 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1425 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1426 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1427
1428 @c @group
1429 @table @code
1430 @kindex info
1431 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1432 @item info
1433 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1434 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1435 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1436 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1437 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1438 @w{@code{help info}}.
1439
1440 @kindex set
1441 @item set
1442 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1443 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1444 @code{set prompt $}.
1445
1446 @kindex show
1447 @item show
1448 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1449 @value{GDBN} itself.
1450 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1451 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1452 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1453 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1454
1455 @kindex info set
1456 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1457 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1458 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1459 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1460 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1461 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1462 @end table
1463 @c @end group
1464
1465 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1466 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1467
1468 @table @code
1469 @kindex show version
1470 @cindex version number
1471 @item show version
1472 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1473 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1474 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1475 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1476 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1477 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1478 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1479 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1480 @value{GDBN}.
1481
1482 @kindex show copying
1483 @item show copying
1484 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1485
1486 @kindex show warranty
1487 @item show warranty
1488 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1489 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1490
1491 @end table
1492
1493 @node Running
1494 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1495
1496 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1497 debugging information when you compile it.
1498
1499 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1500 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1501 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1502 kill a child process.
1503
1504 @menu
1505 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1506 * Starting:: Starting your program
1507 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1508 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1509
1510 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1511 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1512 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1513 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1514
1515 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1516 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1517 @end menu
1518
1519 @node Compilation
1520 @section Compiling for debugging
1521
1522 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1523 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1524 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1525 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1526 and addresses in the executable code.
1527
1528 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1529 the compiler.
1530
1531 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1532 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1533 executables containing debugging information.
1534
1535 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1536 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1537 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1538 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1539 in pushing your luck.
1540
1541 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1542 @cindex debugging optimized code
1543 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1544 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1545 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1546 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1547 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1548 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1549
1550 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1551 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1552 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1553 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1554
1555 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1556 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1557 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1558
1559 @need 2000
1560 @node Starting
1561 @section Starting your program
1562 @cindex starting
1563 @cindex running
1564
1565 @table @code
1566 @kindex run
1567 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1568 @item run
1569 @itemx r
1570 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1571 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1572 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1573 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1574 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1575
1576 @end table
1577
1578 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1579 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1580 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1581 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1582
1583 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1584 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1585 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1586 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1587 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1588 divided into four categories:
1589
1590 @table @asis
1591 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1592 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1593 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1594 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1595 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1596 the arguments.
1597 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1598 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1599 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1600
1601 @item The @emph{environment.}
1602 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1603 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1604 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1605 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1606
1607 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1608 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1609 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1610 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1611
1612 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1613 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1614 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1615 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1616 set a different device for your program.
1617 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1618
1619 @cindex pipes
1620 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1621 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1622 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1623 wrong program.
1624 @end table
1625
1626 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1627 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1628 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1629 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1630 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1631
1632 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1633 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1634 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1635 your current breakpoints.
1636
1637 @node Arguments
1638 @section Your program's arguments
1639
1640 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1641 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1642 @code{run} command.
1643 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1644 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1645 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1646 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1647 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1648
1649 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1650 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1651 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1652 the program, not by the shell.
1653
1654 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1655 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1656
1657 @table @code
1658 @kindex set args
1659 @item set args
1660 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1661 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1662 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1663 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1664 it again without arguments.
1665
1666 @kindex show args
1667 @item show args
1668 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1669 @end table
1670
1671 @node Environment
1672 @section Your program's environment
1673
1674 @cindex environment (of your program)
1675 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1676 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1677 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1678 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1679 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1680 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1681 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1682
1683 @table @code
1684 @kindex path
1685 @item path @var{directory}
1686 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1687 (the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
1688 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1692
1693 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698 @var{directory} to the search path.
1699 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702 @kindex show paths
1703 @item show paths
1704 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705 environment variable).
1706
1707 @kindex show environment
1708 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714 @kindex set environment
1715 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1716 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721 null value.
1722 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725 For example, this command:
1726
1727 @example
1728 set env USER = foo
1729 @end example
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1733 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734 are not actually required.)
1735
1736 @kindex unset environment
1737 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1738 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742 @end table
1743
1744 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745 the shell indicated
1746 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752 @file{.profile}.
1753
1754 @node Working Directory
1755 @section Your program's working directory
1756
1757 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1758 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766 specify files}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex cd
1770 @item cd @var{directory}
1771 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773 @kindex pwd
1774 @item pwd
1775 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776 @end table
1777
1778 @node Input/Output
1779 @section Your program's input and output
1780
1781 @cindex redirection
1782 @cindex i/o
1783 @cindex terminal
1784 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1785 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1786 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788 running your program.
1789
1790 @table @code
1791 @kindex info terminal
1792 @item info terminal
1793 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794 program is using.
1795 @end table
1796
1797 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800 @example
1801 run > outfile
1802 @end example
1803
1804 @noindent
1805 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807 @kindex tty
1808 @cindex controlling terminal
1809 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815 @example
1816 tty /dev/ttyb
1817 @end example
1818
1819 @noindent
1820 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822 that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826 terminal.
1827
1828 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
1832 @node Attach
1833 @section Debugging an already-running process
1834 @kindex attach
1835 @cindex attach
1836
1837 @table @code
1838 @item attach @var{process-id}
1839 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846 executing the command.
1847 @end table
1848
1849 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859 Specify Files}.
1860
1861 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1863 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1867 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869 @table @code
1870 @kindex detach
1871 @item detach
1872 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878 executing the command.
1879 @end table
1880
1881 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886 messages}).
1887
1888 @node Kill Process
1889 @section Killing the child process
1890
1891 @table @code
1892 @kindex kill
1893 @item kill
1894 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895 @end table
1896
1897 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899 is running.
1900
1901 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904 outside the debugger.
1905
1906 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911 breakpoint settings).
1912
1913 @node Threads
1914 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1915
1916 @cindex threads of execution
1917 @cindex multiple threads
1918 @cindex switching threads
1919 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928 programs:
1929
1930 @itemize @bullet
1931 @item automatic notification of new threads
1932 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1934 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1935 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936 @item thread-specific breakpoints
1937 @end itemize
1938
1939 @quotation
1940 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945 like this:
1946
1947 @smallexample
1948 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951 see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952 @end smallexample
1953 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954 @c doesn't support threads"?
1955 @end quotation
1956
1957 @cindex focus of debugging
1958 @cindex current thread
1959 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
1965 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
1966 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1967 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974 LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976 @example
1977 [New process 35 thread 27]
1978 @end example
1979
1980 @noindent
1981 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983 further qualifier.
1984
1985 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987 @c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988 @c program?
1989 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1991 @c threads ab initio?
1992
1993 @cindex thread number
1994 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998 @table @code
1999 @kindex info threads
2000 @item info threads
2001 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004 @enumerate
2005 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010 @end enumerate
2011
2012 @noindent
2013 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014 indicates the current thread.
2015
2016 For example,
2017 @end table
2018 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020 @smallexample
2021 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026 @end smallexample
2027
2028 On HP-UX systems:
2029
2030 @cindex thread number
2031 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034 thread in your program.
2035
2036 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2038 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045 HP-UX, you see
2046
2047 @example
2048 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049 @end example
2050
2051 @noindent
2052 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2053
2054 @table @code
2055 @kindex info threads
2056 @item info threads
2057 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060 @enumerate
2061 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066 @end enumerate
2067
2068 @noindent
2069 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070 indicates the current thread.
2071
2072 For example,
2073 @end table
2074 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076 @example
2077 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2084 @end example
2085
2086 @table @code
2087 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088 @item thread @var{threadno}
2089 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095 @smallexample
2096 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2098 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2099 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100 @end smallexample
2101
2102 @noindent
2103 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2105 threads.
2106
2107 @kindex thread apply
2108 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2113 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2115 @end table
2116
2117 @cindex automatic thread selection
2118 @cindex switching threads automatically
2119 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2120 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124 thread.
2125
2126 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128 programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2132
2133 @node Processes
2134 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137 @cindex multiple processes
2138 @cindex processes, multiple
2139 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145 will cause it to terminate.
2146
2147 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2155 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2156 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2157
2158 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2161
2162 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168 @table @code
2169 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175 @table @code
2176 @item parent
2177 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2178 unimpeded. This is the default.
2179
2180 @item child
2181 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182 unimpeded.
2183
2184 @item ask
2185 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186 @end table
2187
2188 @item show follow-fork-mode
2189 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2190 @end table
2191
2192 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196 the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204 argument.
2205
2206 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2209
2210 @node Stopping
2211 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
2217 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223 explicitly request this information at any time.
2224
2225 @table @code
2226 @kindex info program
2227 @item info program
2228 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2229 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2230 @end table
2231
2232 @menu
2233 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2235 * Signals:: Signals
2236 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2237 @end menu
2238
2239 @node Breakpoints
2240 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242 @cindex breakpoints
2243 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249 program.
2250
2251 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258 @cindex watchpoints
2259 @cindex memory tracing
2260 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271 Automatic display}.
2272
2273 @cindex catchpoints
2274 @cindex breakpoint on events
2275 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2276 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2277 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2281 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2282
2283 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2284 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291 enable it again.
2292
2293 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2294 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
2301 @menu
2302 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2308 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2309 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2310 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2311 @end menu
2312
2313 @node Set Breaks
2314 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
2316 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2317 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318 @c
2319 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321 @kindex break
2322 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2324 @cindex latest breakpoint
2325 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2326 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2327 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2328 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329 convenience variables.
2330
2331 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333 @table @code
2334 @item break @var{function}
2335 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2336 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2337 C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2338 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2339
2340 @item break +@var{offset}
2341 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2342 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2343 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2344 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2345
2346 @item break @var{linenum}
2347 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2348 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2350 code on that line.
2351
2352 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359 functions.
2360
2361 @item break *@var{address}
2362 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364 information or source files.
2365
2366 @item break
2367 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376 inside loops.
2377
2378 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382 existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392 @kindex tbreak
2393 @item tbreak @var{args}
2394 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
2399 @kindex hbreak
2400 @item hbreak @var{args}
2401 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2403 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2405 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2415
2416 @kindex thbreak
2417 @item thbreak @var{args}
2418 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2420 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2421 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2423 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2425 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2426
2427 @kindex rbreak
2428 @cindex regular expression
2429 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2430 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2431 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2443
2444 When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2445 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446 classes.
2447
2448 @kindex info breakpoints
2449 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456 @table @emph
2457 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2458 @item Type
2459 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460 @item Disposition
2461 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462 @item Enabled or Disabled
2463 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464 that are not enabled.
2465 @item Address
2466 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2467 @item What
2468 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469 line number.
2470 @end table
2471
2472 @noindent
2473 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475 are listed after that.
2476
2477 @noindent
2478 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2482 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2483
2484 @noindent
2485 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491 @end table
2492
2493 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501 purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502 These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503 @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506 @samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508 @table @code
2509 @kindex maint info breakpoints
2510 @item maint info breakpoints
2511 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515 is shown:
2516
2517 @table @code
2518 @item breakpoint
2519 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521 @item watchpoint
2522 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524 @item longjmp
2525 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526 @code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528 @item longjmp resume
2529 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531 @item until
2532 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534 @item finish
2535 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
2537 @item shlib events
2538 Shared library events.
2539
2540 @end table
2541
2542 @end table
2543
2544
2545 @node Set Watchpoints
2546 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548 @cindex setting watchpoints
2549 @cindex software watchpoints
2550 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2551 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553 this may happen.
2554
2555 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2556 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2557 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560 culprit.)
2561
2562 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2563 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2564 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565 program.
2566
2567 @table @code
2568 @kindex watch
2569 @item watch @var{expr}
2570 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573 @kindex rwatch
2574 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2575 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2576
2577 @kindex awatch
2578 @item awatch @var{expr}
2579 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2580 by the program.
2581
2582 @kindex info watchpoints
2583 @item info watchpoints
2584 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586 @end table
2587
2588 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597 @example
2598 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599 @end example
2600
2601 @noindent
2602 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
2604 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610 will print a message like this:
2611
2612 @smallexample
2613 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614 @end smallexample
2615
2616 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632 @smallexample
2633 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634 @end smallexample
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2647 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2651 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2652 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
2654 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
2664 @quotation
2665 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2666 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2667 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674 the expression.
2675
2676 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2677 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2686 @end quotation
2687
2688 @node Set Catchpoints
2689 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2690 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2691 @cindex exception handlers
2692 @cindex event handling
2693
2694 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2695 kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2696 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698 @table @code
2699 @kindex catch
2700 @item catch @var{event}
2701 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702 @table @code
2703 @item throw
2704 @kindex catch throw
2705 The throwing of a C++ exception.
2706
2707 @item catch
2708 @kindex catch catch
2709 The catching of a C++ exception.
2710
2711 @item exec
2712 @kindex catch exec
2713 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715 @item fork
2716 @kindex catch fork
2717 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719 @item vfork
2720 @kindex catch vfork
2721 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723 @item load
2724 @itemx load @var{libname}
2725 @kindex catch load
2726 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729 @item unload
2730 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2731 @kindex catch unload
2732 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 @item tcatch @var{event}
2737 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740 @end table
2741
2742 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
2744 There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2745 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747 @itemize @bullet
2748 @item
2749 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756 disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758 @item
2759 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761 @item
2762 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763 @end itemize
2764
2765 @cindex raise exceptions
2766 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771 out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2774 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2775 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778 @example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2782 @end example
2783
2784 @noindent
2785 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793 raised.
2794
2795
2796 @node Delete Breaks
2797 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809 their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex clear
2817 @item clear
2818 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823 @item clear @var{function}
2824 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827 @item clear @var{linenum}
2828 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831 @cindex delete breakpoints
2832 @kindex delete
2833 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2834 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2837 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839 @end table
2840
2841 @node Disabling
2842 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844 @kindex disable breakpoints
2845 @kindex enable breakpoints
2846 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858 states of enablement:
2859
2860 @itemize @bullet
2861 @item
2862 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864 @item
2865 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866 @item
2867 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2868 disabled.
2869 @item
2870 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2871 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2873 @end itemize
2874
2875 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @kindex disable breakpoints
2880 @kindex disable
2881 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2882 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2883 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889 @kindex enable breakpoints
2890 @kindex enable
2891 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2892 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
2895 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2896 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
2899 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2900 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902 @end table
2903
2904 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2906 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912 stepping}.)
2913
2914 @node Conditions
2915 @subsection Break conditions
2916 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2917 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2920 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2921 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938 one.
2939
2940 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2947 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948 conditions for the
2949 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955 with the @code{condition} command.
2956
2957 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960 catchpoint.
2961
2962 @table @code
2963 @kindex condition
2964 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2971 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973 prints an error message:
2974
2975 @example
2976 No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977 @end example
2978
2979 @noindent
2980 @value{GDBN} does
2981 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2982 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2984
2985 @item condition @var{bnum}
2986 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988 @end table
2989
2990 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000 your program reaches it.
3001
3002 @table @code
3003 @kindex ignore
3004 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008 takes no action.
3009
3010 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011 a count of zero.
3012
3013 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025 variables}.
3026 @end table
3027
3028 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
3031 @node Break Commands
3032 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034 @cindex breakpoint commands
3035 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038 enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040 @table @code
3041 @kindex commands
3042 @kindex end
3043 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045 @itemx end
3046 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055 recently encountered).
3056 @end table
3057
3058 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063 that resumes execution.
3064
3065 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071 @kindex silent
3072 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086 @example
3087 break foo if x>0
3088 commands
3089 silent
3090 printf "x is %d\n",x
3091 cont
3092 end
3093 @end example
3094
3095 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103 @example
3104 break 403
3105 commands
3106 silent
3107 set x = y + 4
3108 cont
3109 end
3110 @end example
3111
3112 @node Breakpoint Menus
3113 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3114 @cindex overloading
3115 @cindex symbol overloading
3116
3117 Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3118 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129 breakpoints.
3130
3131 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136 @smallexample
3137 @group
3138 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139 [0] cancel
3140 [1] all
3141 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147 > 2 4 6
3148 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154 (@value{GDBP})
3155 @end group
3156 @end smallexample
3157
3158 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3159 @node Error in Breakpoints
3160 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3161 @c
3162 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163 @c
3164 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3166 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3167 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169 @example
3170 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171 The same program may be running in another process.
3172 @end example
3173
3174 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176 @enumerate
3177 @item
3178 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180 @item
3181 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3182 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3183 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3184 Then start your program again.
3185
3186 @item
3187 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189 to nonsharable executables.
3190 @end enumerate
3191 @c @end ifclear
3192
3193 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198 @smallexample
3199 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201 @end smallexample
3202
3203 @noindent
3204 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
3212 @node Continuing and Stepping
3213 @section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215 @cindex stepping
3216 @cindex continuing
3217 @cindex resuming execution
3218 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3222 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3224 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3226
3227 @table @code
3228 @kindex continue
3229 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3231 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242 @code{continue} is ignored.
3243
3244 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247 @code{continue}.
3248 @end table
3249
3250 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262 @table @code
3263 @kindex step
3264 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3265 @item step
3266 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268 abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270 @quotation
3271 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274 @c distinction here.
3275 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281 below.
3282 @end quotation
3283
3284 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3285 source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286 switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3287 function that has debugging information is called within the line.
3288 In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3289 within the line.
3290
3291 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3293 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3294 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3295 was any debugging information about the routine.
3296
3297 @item step @var{count}
3298 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3299 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3301
3302 @kindex next
3303 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3304 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3306 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3311
3312 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317 @c
3318 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320 @c function are executed without stopping.
3321
3322 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3324 switch statements, for loops, etc.
3325
3326 @kindex set step-mode
3327 @item set step-mode
3328 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330 @itemx set step-mode on
3331 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to to
3332 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333 information rather than stepping over it.
3334
3335 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the assembly
3336 language of a function which has no symbolic info and do not want @value{GDBN}
3337 to automatically skip over this function.
3338
3339 @item set step-mode off
3340 Causes the step command to step over any functions which contains no
3341 debug information. This is the default.
3342
3343 @kindex finish
3344 @item finish
3345 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349 ,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351 @kindex until
3352 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3353 @item until
3354 @itemx u
3355 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360 than the address of the jump.
3361
3362 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366 through the next iteration.
3367
3368 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369 stack frame.
3370
3371 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377 @example
3378 (@value{GDBP}) f
3379 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380 206 expand_input();
3381 (@value{GDBP}) until
3382 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383 @end example
3384
3385 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395 argument.
3396
3397 @item until @var{location}
3398 @itemx u @var{location}
3399 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405 @kindex stepi
3406 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3407 @item stepi
3408 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3409 @itemx si
3410 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415 Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419 @need 750
3420 @kindex nexti
3421 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3422 @item nexti
3423 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3424 @itemx ni
3425 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426 proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429 @end table
3430
3431 @node Signals
3432 @section Signals
3433 @cindex signals
3434
3435 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3438 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3439 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442 requested an alarm).
3443
3444 @cindex fatal signals
3445 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3447 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3448 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454 signal.
3455
3456 @cindex handling signals
3457 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3458 (so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3459 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3460 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3461
3462 @table @code
3463 @kindex info signals
3464 @item info signals
3465 @itemx info handle
3466 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3467 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3468 the defined types of signals.
3469
3470 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3471
3472 @kindex handle
3473 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3474 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3475 be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3476 beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3477 @end table
3478
3479 @c @group
3480 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3481 Their full names are:
3482
3483 @table @code
3484 @item nostop
3485 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3486 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3487
3488 @item stop
3489 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3490 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3491
3492 @item print
3493 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3494
3495 @item noprint
3496 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3497 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3498
3499 @item pass
3500 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3501 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3502 and not handled.
3503
3504 @item nopass
3505 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3506 @end table
3507 @c @end group
3508
3509 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3510 program until you
3511 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3512 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3513 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3514 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3515 program sees that signal when you continue.
3516
3517 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3518 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3519 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3520 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3521 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3522 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3523 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3524 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3525 program a signal}.
3526
3527 @node Thread Stops
3528 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529
3530 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3531 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3532 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3533
3534 @table @code
3535 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3536 @cindex thread breakpoints
3537 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3538 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3539 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3540 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3541 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3542
3543 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3544 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3545 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3546 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3547 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3548
3549 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3550 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3551 program.
3552
3553 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3554 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3555 breakpoint condition, like this:
3556
3557 @smallexample
3558 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3559 @end smallexample
3560
3561 @end table
3562
3563 @cindex stopped threads
3564 @cindex threads, stopped
3565 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3566 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3567 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3568 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3569 underfoot.
3570
3571 @cindex continuing threads
3572 @cindex threads, continuing
3573 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3574 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3575 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3576
3577 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3578 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3579 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3580 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3581 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3582 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3583 stops.
3584
3585 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3586 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3587 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3588 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3589
3590 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3591 thread to run.
3592
3593 @table @code
3594 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3595 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3596 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3597 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3598 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3599 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3600 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3601 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3602 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3603 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3604 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3605 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3606
3607 @item show scheduler-locking
3608 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3609 @end table
3610
3611
3612 @node Stack
3613 @chapter Examining the Stack
3614
3615 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3616 stopped and how it got there.
3617
3618 @cindex call stack
3619 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3620 is generated.
3621 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3622 the arguments of the call,
3623 and the local variables of the function being called.
3624 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3625 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3626 stack}.
3627
3628 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3629 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3630
3631 @cindex selected frame
3632 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3633 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3634 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3635 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3636 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3637 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3638
3639 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3640 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3641 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3642
3643 @menu
3644 * Frames:: Stack frames
3645 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3646 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3647 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3648
3649 @end menu
3650
3651 @node Frames
3652 @section Stack frames
3653
3654 @cindex frame, definition
3655 @cindex stack frame
3656 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3657 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3658 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3659 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3660 which the function is executing.
3661
3662 @cindex initial frame
3663 @cindex outermost frame
3664 @cindex innermost frame
3665 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3666 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3667 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3668 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3669 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3670 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3671 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3672 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3673
3674 @cindex frame pointer
3675 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3676 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3677 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3678 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3679 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3680 going on in that frame.
3681
3682 @cindex frame number
3683 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3684 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3685 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3686 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3687 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3688
3689 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3690 @c underflow problems.
3691 @cindex frameless execution
3692 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3693 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3694 @example
3695 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3696 @end example
3697 generates functions without a frame.)
3698 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3699 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3700 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3701 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3702 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3703 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3704 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3705
3706 @table @code
3707 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3708 @cindex current stack frame
3709 @item frame @var{args}
3710 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3711 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3712 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3713 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3714
3715 @kindex select-frame
3716 @cindex selecting frame silently
3717 @item select-frame
3718 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3719 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3720 @code{frame}.
3721 @end table
3722
3723 @node Backtrace
3724 @section Backtraces
3725
3726 @cindex backtraces
3727 @cindex tracebacks
3728 @cindex stack traces
3729 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3730 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3731 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3732 stack.
3733
3734 @table @code
3735 @kindex backtrace
3736 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3737 @item backtrace
3738 @itemx bt
3739 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3740 frames in the stack.
3741
3742 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3743 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3744
3745 @item backtrace @var{n}
3746 @itemx bt @var{n}
3747 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3748
3749 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3750 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3751 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3752 @end table
3753
3754 @kindex where
3755 @kindex info stack
3756 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3757 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3758 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3759
3760 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3761 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3762 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3763 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3764 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3765 line number.
3766
3767 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3768 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3769
3770 @smallexample
3771 @group
3772 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3773 at builtin.c:993
3774 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3775 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3776 at macro.c:71
3777 (More stack frames follow...)
3778 @end group
3779 @end smallexample
3780
3781 @noindent
3782 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3783 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3784 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3785
3786 @node Selection
3787 @section Selecting a frame
3788
3789 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3790 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3791 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3792 of the stack frame just selected.
3793
3794 @table @code
3795 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3796 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3797 @item frame @var{n}
3798 @itemx f @var{n}
3799 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3800 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3801 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3802 @code{main}.
3803
3804 @item frame @var{addr}
3805 @itemx f @var{addr}
3806 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3807 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3808 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3809 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3810 switches between them.
3811
3812 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3813 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3814
3815 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3816 pointer and a program counter.
3817
3818 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3819 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3820 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3821 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3822 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3823
3824 @kindex up
3825 @item up @var{n}
3826 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3827 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3828 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3829
3830 @kindex down
3831 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3832 @item down @var{n}
3833 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3834 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3835 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3836 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3837 @end table
3838
3839 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3840 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3841 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3842 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3843
3844 @need 1000
3845 For example:
3846
3847 @smallexample
3848 @group
3849 (@value{GDBP}) up
3850 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3851 at env.c:10
3852 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3853 @end group
3854 @end smallexample
3855
3856 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3857 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3858 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3859
3860 @table @code
3861 @kindex down-silently
3862 @kindex up-silently
3863 @item up-silently @var{n}
3864 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3865 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3866 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3867 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3868 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3869 distracting.
3870 @end table
3871
3872 @node Frame Info
3873 @section Information about a frame
3874
3875 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3876 stack frame.
3877
3878 @table @code
3879 @item frame
3880 @itemx f
3881 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3882 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3883 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3884 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3885 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3886
3887 @kindex info frame
3888 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3889 @item info frame
3890 @itemx info f
3891 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3892 including:
3893
3894 @itemize @bullet
3895 @item
3896 the address of the frame
3897 @item
3898 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3899 @item
3900 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3901 @item
3902 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3903 @item
3904 the address of the frame's arguments
3905 @item
3906 the address of the frame's local variables
3907 @item
3908 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3909 @item
3910 which registers were saved in the frame
3911 @end itemize
3912
3913 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3914 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3915 the usual conventions.
3916
3917 @item info frame @var{addr}
3918 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3919 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3920 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3921 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3922 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3923 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3924
3925 @kindex info args
3926 @item info args
3927 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3928
3929 @item info locals
3930 @kindex info locals
3931 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3932 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3933 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3934
3935 @kindex info catch
3936 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3937 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
3938 @item info catch
3939 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3940 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3941 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3942 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3943 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3944
3945 @end table
3946
3947
3948 @node Source
3949 @chapter Examining Source Files
3950
3951 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3952 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3953 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3954 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3955 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3956 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3957 source files by explicit command.
3958
3959 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3960 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
3961 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3962
3963 @menu
3964 * List:: Printing source lines
3965 * Search:: Searching source files
3966 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3967 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3968 @end menu
3969
3970 @node List
3971 @section Printing source lines
3972
3973 @kindex list
3974 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
3975 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3976 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3977 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3978
3979 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3980
3981 @table @code
3982 @item list @var{linenum}
3983 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3984 current source file.
3985
3986 @item list @var{function}
3987 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3988 @var{function}.
3989
3990 @item list
3991 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3992 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3993 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3994 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3995 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3996
3997 @item list -
3998 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3999 @end table
4000
4001 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4002 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4003
4004 @table @code
4005 @kindex set listsize
4006 @item set listsize @var{count}
4007 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4008 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4009
4010 @kindex show listsize
4011 @item show listsize
4012 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4013 @end table
4014
4015 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4016 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4017 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4018 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4019 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4020
4021 @cindex linespec
4022 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4023 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4024 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4025 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4026
4027 @table @code
4028 @item list @var{linespec}
4029 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4030
4031 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4032 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4033 linespecs.
4034
4035 @item list ,@var{last}
4036 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4037
4038 @item list @var{first},
4039 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4040
4041 @item list +
4042 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4043
4044 @item list -
4045 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4046
4047 @item list
4048 As described in the preceding table.
4049 @end table
4050
4051 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4052 kinds of linespec.
4053
4054 @table @code
4055 @item @var{number}
4056 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4057 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4058 the same source file as the first linespec.
4059
4060 @item +@var{offset}
4061 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4062 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4063 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4064 first linespec.
4065
4066 @item -@var{offset}
4067 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4068
4069 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4070 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4071
4072 @item @var{function}
4073 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4074 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4075
4076 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4077 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4078 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4079 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4080 identically named functions in different source files.
4081
4082 @item *@var{address}
4083 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4084 @var{address} may be any expression.
4085 @end table
4086
4087 @node Search
4088 @section Searching source files
4089 @cindex searching
4090 @kindex reverse-search
4091
4092 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4093 regular expression.
4094
4095 @table @code
4096 @kindex search
4097 @kindex forward-search
4098 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4099 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4100 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4101 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4102 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4103 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4104 @code{fo}.
4105
4106 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4107 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4108 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4109 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4110 this command as @code{rev}.
4111 @end table
4112
4113 @node Source Path
4114 @section Specifying source directories
4115
4116 @cindex source path
4117 @cindex directories for source files
4118 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4119 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4120 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4121 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4122 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4123 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4124 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4125 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4126 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4127 path.
4128
4129 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4130 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4131 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4132 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4133 last resort.
4134
4135 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4136 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4137 each line is in the file.
4138
4139 @kindex directory
4140 @kindex dir
4141 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4142 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4143 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4144
4145 @table @code
4146 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4147 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4148 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4149 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4150 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4151 part of absolute file names) or
4152 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4153 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4154
4155 @kindex cdir
4156 @kindex cwd
4157 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4158 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4159 @cindex compilation directory
4160 @cindex current directory
4161 @cindex working directory
4162 @cindex directory, current
4163 @cindex directory, compilation
4164 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4165 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4166 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4167 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4168 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4169 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4170
4171 @item directory
4172 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4173
4174 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4175 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4176
4177 @item show directories
4178 @kindex show directories
4179 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4180 @end table
4181
4182 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4183 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4184 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4185
4186 @enumerate
4187 @item
4188 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4189
4190 @item
4191 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4192 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4193 directories in one command.
4194 @end enumerate
4195
4196 @node Machine Code
4197 @section Source and machine code
4198
4199 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4200 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4201 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4202 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4203 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4204 well as hex.
4205
4206 @table @code
4207 @kindex info line
4208 @item info line @var{linespec}
4209 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4210 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4211 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4212 source lines}).
4213 @end table
4214
4215 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4216 the object code for the first line of function
4217 @code{m4_changequote}:
4218
4219 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4220 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4221 @smallexample
4222 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4223 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4224 @end smallexample
4225
4226 @noindent
4227 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4228 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4229 @smallexample
4230 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4231 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4232 @end smallexample
4233
4234 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4235 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4236 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4237 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4238 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4239 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4240 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4241 variables}).
4242
4243 @table @code
4244 @kindex disassemble
4245 @cindex assembly instructions
4246 @cindex instructions, assembly
4247 @cindex machine instructions
4248 @cindex listing machine instructions
4249 @item disassemble
4250 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4251 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4252 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4253 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4254 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4255 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4256 @end table
4257
4258 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4259 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4260
4261 @smallexample
4262 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4263 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4264 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4265 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4266 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4267 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4268 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4269 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4270 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4271 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4272 End of assembler dump.
4273 @end smallexample
4274
4275 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4276 mnemonics or other syntax.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4280 @cindex assembly instructions
4281 @cindex instructions, assembly
4282 @cindex machine instructions
4283 @cindex listing machine instructions
4284 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4285 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4286 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4287 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4288 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4289
4290 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4291 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4292 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4293 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4294 @end table
4295
4296
4297 @node Data
4298 @chapter Examining Data
4299
4300 @cindex printing data
4301 @cindex examining data
4302 @kindex print
4303 @kindex inspect
4304 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4305 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4306 @c different window or something like that.
4307 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4308 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4309 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4310 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4311 Different Languages}).
4312
4313 @table @code
4314 @item print @var{expr}
4315 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4316 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4317 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4318 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4319 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4320 formats}.
4321
4322 @item print
4323 @itemx print /@var{f}
4324 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4325 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4326 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4327 @end table
4328
4329 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4330 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4331 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4332
4333 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4334 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4335 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4336 Table}.
4337
4338 @menu
4339 * Expressions:: Expressions
4340 * Variables:: Program variables
4341 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4342 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4343 * Memory:: Examining memory
4344 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4345 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4346 * Value History:: Value history
4347 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4348 * Registers:: Registers
4349 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4350 @end menu
4351
4352 @node Expressions
4353 @section Expressions
4354
4355 @cindex expressions
4356 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4357 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4358 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4359 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4360 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4361 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4362
4363 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4364 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4365 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4366 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4367
4368 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4369 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4370 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4371 languages.
4372
4373 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4374 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4375
4376 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4377 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4378 at that address in memory.
4379 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4380
4381 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4382 to programming languages:
4383
4384 @table @code
4385 @item @@
4386 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4387 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4388
4389 @item ::
4390 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4391 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4392
4393 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4394 @cindex type casting memory
4395 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4396 @cindex casts, to view memory
4397 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4398 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4399 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4400 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4401 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4402 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4403 @end table
4404
4405 @node Variables
4406 @section Program variables
4407
4408 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4409 in your program.
4410
4411 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4412 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4413
4414 @itemize @bullet
4415 @item
4416 global (or file-static)
4417 @end itemize
4418
4419 @noindent or
4420
4421 @itemize @bullet
4422 @item
4423 visible according to the scope rules of the
4424 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4425 @end itemize
4426
4427 @noindent This means that in the function
4428
4429 @example
4430 foo (a)
4431 int a;
4432 @{
4433 bar (a);
4434 @{
4435 int b = test ();
4436 bar (b);
4437 @}
4438 @}
4439 @end example
4440
4441 @noindent
4442 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4443 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4444 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4445 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4446
4447 @cindex variable name conflict
4448 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4449 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4450 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4451 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4452 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4453 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4454 using the colon-colon notation:
4455
4456 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4457 @iftex
4458 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4459 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4460 @end iftex
4461 @example
4462 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4463 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4464 @end example
4465
4466 @noindent
4467 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4468 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4469 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4470 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4471
4472 @example
4473 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4474 @end example
4475
4476 @cindex C++ scope resolution
4477 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4478 use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4479 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4480 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4481 @c conflict?? --mew
4482
4483 @cindex wrong values
4484 @cindex variable values, wrong
4485 @quotation
4486 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4487 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4488 scope, and just before exit.
4489 @end quotation
4490 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4491 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4492 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4493 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4494 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4495 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4496 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4497 variable definitions may be gone.
4498
4499 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4500 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4501 when compiling.
4502
4503 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4504 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4505 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4506 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4507 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4508 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4509 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4510
4511 @example
4512 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4513 @end example
4514
4515 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4516 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4517 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4518 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4519 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4520 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4521 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4522 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4523 information.
4524
4525
4526 @node Arrays
4527 @section Artificial arrays
4528
4529 @cindex artificial array
4530 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4531 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4532 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4533 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4534 program.
4535
4536 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4537 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4538 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4539 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4540 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4541 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4542 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4543 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4544 example. If a program says
4545
4546 @example
4547 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4548 @end example
4549
4550 @noindent
4551 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4552
4553 @example
4554 p *array@@len
4555 @end example
4556
4557 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4558 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4559 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4560 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4561 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4562
4563 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4564 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4565 The value need not be in memory:
4566 @example
4567 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4568 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4569 @end example
4570
4571 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4572 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4573 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4574 @example
4575 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4576 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4577 @end example
4578
4579 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4580 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4581 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4582 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4583 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4584 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4585 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4586 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4587 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4588 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4589
4590 @example
4591 set $i = 0
4592 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4593 @key{RET}
4594 @key{RET}
4595 @dots{}
4596 @end example
4597
4598 @node Output Formats
4599 @section Output formats
4600
4601 @cindex formatted output
4602 @cindex output formats
4603 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4604 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4605 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4606 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4607 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4608
4609 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4610 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4611 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4612 letters supported are:
4613
4614 @table @code
4615 @item x
4616 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4617 hexadecimal.
4618
4619 @item d
4620 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4621
4622 @item u
4623 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4624
4625 @item o
4626 Print as integer in octal.
4627
4628 @item t
4629 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4630 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4631 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4632 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4633
4634 @item a
4635 @cindex unknown address, locating
4636 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4637 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4638 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4639
4640 @example
4641 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4642 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4643 @end example
4644
4645 @item c
4646 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4647
4648 @item f
4649 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4650 using typical floating point syntax.
4651 @end table
4652
4653 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4654
4655 @example
4656 p/x $pc
4657 @end example
4658
4659 @noindent
4660 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4661 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4662
4663 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4664 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4665 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4666
4667 @node Memory
4668 @section Examining memory
4669
4670 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4671 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4672
4673 @cindex examining memory
4674 @table @code
4675 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4676 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4677 @itemx x @var{addr}
4678 @itemx x
4679 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4680 @end table
4681
4682 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4683 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4684 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4685 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4686 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4687
4688 @table @r
4689 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4690 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4691 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4692 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4693 @c 4.1.2.
4694
4695 @item @var{f}, the display format
4696 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4697 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4698 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4699 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4700
4701 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4702 The unit size is any of
4703
4704 @table @code
4705 @item b
4706 Bytes.
4707 @item h
4708 Halfwords (two bytes).
4709 @item w
4710 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4711 @item g
4712 Giant words (eight bytes).
4713 @end table
4714
4715 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4716 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4717 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4718
4719 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4720 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4721 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4722 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4723 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4724 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4725 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4726 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4727 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4728 a value from memory).
4729 @end table
4730
4731 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4732 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4733 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4734 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4735 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4736
4737 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4738 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4739 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4740 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4741 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4742
4743 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4744 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4745 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4746 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4747 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4748 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4749
4750 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4751 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4752 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4753 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4754 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4755 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4756 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4757
4758 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4759 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4760 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4761 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4762 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4763 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4764 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4765 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4766 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4767
4768 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4769 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4770 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4771
4772 @node Auto Display
4773 @section Automatic display
4774 @cindex automatic display
4775 @cindex display of expressions
4776
4777 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4778 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4779 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4780 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4781 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4782 The automatic display looks like this:
4783
4784 @example
4785 2: foo = 38
4786 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4787 @end example
4788
4789 @noindent
4790 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4791 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4792 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4793 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4794 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4795 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4796 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4797
4798 @table @code
4799 @kindex display
4800 @item display @var{expr}
4801 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4802 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4803
4804 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4805
4806 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4807 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4808 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4809 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4810 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4811
4812 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4813 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4814 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4815 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4816 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4820 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4821 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4822
4823 @table @code
4824 @kindex delete display
4825 @kindex undisplay
4826 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4827 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4828 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4829
4830 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4831 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4832
4833 @kindex disable display
4834 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4835 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4836 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4837 enabled again later.
4838
4839 @kindex enable display
4840 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4841 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4842 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4843
4844 @item display
4845 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4846 done when your program stops.
4847
4848 @kindex info display
4849 @item info display
4850 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4851 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4852 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4853 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4854 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4855 @end table
4856
4857 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4858 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4859 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4860 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4861 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4862 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4863 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4864 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4865 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4866 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4867
4868 @node Print Settings
4869 @section Print settings
4870
4871 @cindex format options
4872 @cindex print settings
4873 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4874 and symbols are printed.
4875
4876 @noindent
4877 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4878
4879 @table @code
4880 @kindex set print address
4881 @item set print address
4882 @itemx set print address on
4883 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4884 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4885 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4886 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4887 @code{set print address on}:
4888
4889 @smallexample
4890 @group
4891 (@value{GDBP}) f
4892 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4893 at input.c:530
4894 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4895 @end group
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @item set print address off
4899 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4900 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4901
4902 @smallexample
4903 @group
4904 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4905 (@value{GDBP}) f
4906 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4907 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4908 @end group
4909 @end smallexample
4910
4911 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4912 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4913 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4914 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4915
4916 @kindex show print address
4917 @item show print address
4918 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4919 @end table
4920
4921 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4922 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4923 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4924 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4925 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4926 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4927 it prints a symbolic address:
4928
4929 @table @code
4930 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4931 @item set print symbol-filename on
4932 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4933 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4934
4935 @item set print symbol-filename off
4936 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4937 default.
4938
4939 @kindex show print symbol-filename
4940 @item show print symbol-filename
4941 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4942 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4943 @end table
4944
4945 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4946 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4947 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4948
4949 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4950 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4951
4952 @table @code
4953 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4954 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4955 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4956 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4957 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4958 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4959
4960 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4961 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
4962 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4963 symbolic address.
4964 @end table
4965
4966 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4967 @cindex pointer, finding referent
4968 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4969 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4970 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4971 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4972 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4973 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4974
4975 @example
4976 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4977 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4978 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4979 @end example
4980
4981 @quotation
4982 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4983 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4984 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4985 @end quotation
4986
4987 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4988
4989 @table @code
4990 @kindex set print array
4991 @item set print array
4992 @itemx set print array on
4993 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4994 but uses more space. The default is off.
4995
4996 @item set print array off
4997 Return to compressed format for arrays.
4998
4999 @kindex show print array
5000 @item show print array
5001 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5002 arrays.
5003
5004 @kindex set print elements
5005 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5006 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5007 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5008 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5009 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5010 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5011 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5012
5013 @kindex show print elements
5014 @item show print elements
5015 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5016 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5017
5018 @kindex set print null-stop
5019 @item set print null-stop
5020 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5021 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5022 contain only short strings.
5023 The default is off.
5024
5025 @kindex set print pretty
5026 @item set print pretty on
5027 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5028 per line, like this:
5029
5030 @smallexample
5031 @group
5032 $1 = @{
5033 next = 0x0,
5034 flags = @{
5035 sweet = 1,
5036 sour = 1
5037 @},
5038 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5039 @}
5040 @end group
5041 @end smallexample
5042
5043 @item set print pretty off
5044 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5045
5046 @smallexample
5047 @group
5048 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5049 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5050 @end group
5051 @end smallexample
5052
5053 @noindent
5054 This is the default format.
5055
5056 @kindex show print pretty
5057 @item show print pretty
5058 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5059
5060 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5061 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5062 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5063 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5064 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5065 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5066 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5067
5068 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5069 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5070 international character sets, and is the default.
5071
5072 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5073 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5074 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5075
5076 @kindex set print union
5077 @item set print union on
5078 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5079 is the default setting.
5080
5081 @item set print union off
5082 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5083
5084 @kindex show print union
5085 @item show print union
5086 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5087 structures.
5088
5089 For example, given the declarations
5090
5091 @smallexample
5092 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5093 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5094 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5095 Bug_forms;
5096
5097 struct thing @{
5098 Species it;
5099 union @{
5100 Tree_forms tree;
5101 Bug_forms bug;
5102 @} form;
5103 @};
5104
5105 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5106 @end smallexample
5107
5108 @noindent
5109 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5110
5111 @smallexample
5112 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5113 @end smallexample
5114
5115 @noindent
5116 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5117
5118 @smallexample
5119 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5120 @end smallexample
5121 @end table
5122
5123 @need 1000
5124 @noindent
5125 These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5126
5127 @table @code
5128 @cindex demangling
5129 @kindex set print demangle
5130 @item set print demangle
5131 @itemx set print demangle on
5132 Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5133 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5134 linkage. The default is on.
5135
5136 @kindex show print demangle
5137 @item show print demangle
5138 Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5139
5140 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5141 @item set print asm-demangle
5142 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5143 Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5144 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5145 The default is off.
5146
5147 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5148 @item show print asm-demangle
5149 Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5150 or demangled form.
5151
5152 @kindex set demangle-style
5153 @cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5154 @cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5155 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5156 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5157 represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5158
5159 @table @code
5160 @item auto
5161 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5162
5163 @item gnu
5164 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5165 This is the default.
5166
5167 @item hp
5168 Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5169
5170 @item lucid
5171 Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5172
5173 @item arm
5174 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5175 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5176 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5177 require further enhancement to permit that.
5178
5179 @end table
5180 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5181
5182 @kindex show demangle-style
5183 @item show demangle-style
5184 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5185
5186 @kindex set print object
5187 @item set print object
5188 @itemx set print object on
5189 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5190 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5191 the virtual function table.
5192
5193 @item set print object off
5194 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5195 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5196
5197 @kindex show print object
5198 @item show print object
5199 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5200
5201 @kindex set print static-members
5202 @item set print static-members
5203 @itemx set print static-members on
5204 Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5205
5206 @item set print static-members off
5207 Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5208
5209 @kindex show print static-members
5210 @item show print static-members
5211 Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5212
5213 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5214 @kindex set print vtbl
5215 @item set print vtbl
5216 @itemx set print vtbl on
5217 Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
5218 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5219 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5220
5221 @item set print vtbl off
5222 Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5223
5224 @kindex show print vtbl
5225 @item show print vtbl
5226 Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5227 @end table
5228
5229 @node Value History
5230 @section Value history
5231
5232 @cindex value history
5233 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5234 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5235 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5236 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5237 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5238 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5239 symbol table.
5240
5241 @cindex @code{$}
5242 @cindex @code{$$}
5243 @cindex history number
5244 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5245 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5246 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5247 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5248 history number.
5249
5250 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5251 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5252 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5253 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5254 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5255 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5256 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5257
5258 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5259 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5260
5261 @example
5262 p *$
5263 @end example
5264
5265 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5266 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5267
5268 @example
5269 p *$.next
5270 @end example
5271
5272 @noindent
5273 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5274 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5275
5276 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5277 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5278
5279 @example
5280 print x
5281 set x=5
5282 @end example
5283
5284 @noindent
5285 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5286 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5287
5288 @table @code
5289 @kindex show values
5290 @item show values
5291 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5292 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5293 values} does not change the history.
5294
5295 @item show values @var{n}
5296 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5297
5298 @item show values +
5299 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5300 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5301 @end table
5302
5303 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5304 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5305
5306 @node Convenience Vars
5307 @section Convenience variables
5308
5309 @cindex convenience variables
5310 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5311 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5312 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5313 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5314 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5315
5316 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5317 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5318 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5319 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5320 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5321
5322 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5323 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5324 For example:
5325
5326 @example
5327 set $foo = *object_ptr
5328 @end example
5329
5330 @noindent
5331 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5332 @code{object_ptr}.
5333
5334 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5335 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5336 value with another assignment at any time.
5337
5338 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5339 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5340 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5341 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5342
5343 @table @code
5344 @kindex show convenience
5345 @item show convenience
5346 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5347 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5348 @end table
5349
5350 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5351 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5352 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5353
5354 @example
5355 set $i = 0
5356 print bar[$i++]->contents
5357 @end example
5358
5359 @noindent
5360 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5361
5362 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5363 values likely to be useful.
5364
5365 @table @code
5366 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5367 @item $_
5368 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5369 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5370 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5371 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5372 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5373 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5374 to the type of @code{$__}.
5375
5376 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5377 @item $__
5378 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5379 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5380 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5381
5382 @item $_exitcode
5383 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5384 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5385 the program being debugged terminates.
5386 @end table
5387
5388 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5389 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5390 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5391
5392 @node Registers
5393 @section Registers
5394
5395 @cindex registers
5396 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5397 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5398 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5399 your machine.
5400
5401 @table @code
5402 @kindex info registers
5403 @item info registers
5404 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5405 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5406
5407 @kindex info all-registers
5408 @cindex floating point registers
5409 @item info all-registers
5410 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5411 registers.
5412
5413 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5414 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5415 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5416 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5417 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5418 @end table
5419
5420 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5421 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5422 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5423 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5424 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5425 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5426 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5427 you could print the program counter in hex with
5428
5429 @example
5430 p/x $pc
5431 @end example
5432
5433 @noindent
5434 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5435
5436 @example
5437 x/i $pc
5438 @end example
5439
5440 @noindent
5441 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5442 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5443 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5444 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5445 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5446 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5447 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5448
5449 @example
5450 set $sp += 4
5451 @end example
5452
5453 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5454 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5455 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5456 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5457 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5458 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5459 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5460
5461 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5462 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5463 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5464 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5465 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5466 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5467 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5468
5469 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5470 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5471 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5472 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5473 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5474 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5475 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5476 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5477 prints the data in both formats.
5478
5479 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5480 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5481 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5482 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5483 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5484 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5485
5486 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5487 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5488 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5489 frame makes no difference.
5490
5491 @node Floating Point Hardware
5492 @section Floating point hardware
5493 @cindex floating point
5494
5495 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5496 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5497
5498 @table @code
5499 @kindex info float
5500 @item info float
5501 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5502 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5503 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5504 the ARM and x86 machines.
5505 @end table
5506
5507 @node Languages
5508 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5509 @cindex languages
5510
5511 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5512 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5513 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5514 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5515 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5516 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
5517
5518 @cindex working language
5519 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5520 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5521 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5522 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5523 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5524 language}.
5525
5526 @menu
5527 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
5528 * Show:: Displaying the language
5529 * Checks:: Type and range checks
5530 * Support:: Supported languages
5531 @end menu
5532
5533 @node Setting
5534 @section Switching between source languages
5535
5536 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5537 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5538 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5539 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5540 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5541 are printed, etc.
5542
5543 In addition to the working language, every source file that
5544 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5545 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5546 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5547 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5548 controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5549 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
5550 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5551 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5552 Displaying the language}.
5553
5554 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5555 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5556 another language. In that case, make the
5557 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5558 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5559 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5560
5561 @menu
5562 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5563 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5564 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5565 @end menu
5566
5567 @node Filenames
5568 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5569
5570 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5571 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5572
5573 @table @file
5574
5575 @item .c
5576 C source file
5577
5578 @item .C
5579 @itemx .cc
5580 @itemx .cp
5581 @itemx .cpp
5582 @itemx .cxx
5583 @itemx .c++
5584 C++ source file
5585
5586 @item .f
5587 @itemx .F
5588 Fortran source file
5589
5590 @item .ch
5591 @itemx .c186
5592 @itemx .c286
5593 CHILL source file
5594
5595 @item .mod
5596 Modula-2 source file
5597
5598 @item .s
5599 @itemx .S
5600 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5601 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5602 @end table
5603
5604 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5605 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5606
5607 @node Manually
5608 @subsection Setting the working language
5609
5610 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5611 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5612 your program.
5613
5614 @kindex set language
5615 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5616 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5617 a language, such as
5618 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
5619 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5620
5621 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5622 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5623 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5624 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5625 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5626 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5627 command such as:
5628
5629 @example
5630 print a = b + c
5631 @end example
5632
5633 @noindent
5634 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5635 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5636 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5637 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
5638
5639 @node Automatically
5640 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5641
5642 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5643 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5644 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5645 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5646 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5647 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5648 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5649 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5650 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5651
5652 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5653 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5654 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5655 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5656 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5657
5658 @node Show
5659 @section Displaying the language
5660
5661 The following commands help you find out which language is the
5662 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5663
5664 @kindex show language
5665 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5666 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
5667 @table @code
5668 @item show language
5669 Display the current working language. This is the
5670 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5671 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5672
5673 @item info frame
5674 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5675 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5676 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5677 information listed here.
5678
5679 @item info source
5680 Display the source language of this source file.
5681 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5682 information listed here.
5683 @end table
5684
5685 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5686 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5687 with a language explicitly:
5688
5689 @kindex set extension-language
5690 @kindex info extensions
5691 @table @code
5692 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5693 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5694 the source language @var{language}.
5695
5696 @item info extensions
5697 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5698 @end table
5699
5700 @node Checks
5701 @section Type and range checking
5702
5703 @quotation
5704 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5705 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5706 section documents the intended facilities.
5707 @end quotation
5708 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5709
5710 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5711 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5712 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5713 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5714 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5715 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5716 errors when your program is running.
5717
5718 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5719 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5720 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5721 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5722 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5723 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5724 for the default settings of supported languages.
5725
5726 @menu
5727 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5728 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5729 @end menu
5730
5731 @cindex type checking
5732 @cindex checks, type
5733 @node Type Checking
5734 @subsection An overview of type checking
5735
5736 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5737 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5738 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5739 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5740
5741 @smallexample
5742 1 + 2 @result{} 3
5743 @exdent but
5744 @error{} 1 + 2.3
5745 @end smallexample
5746
5747 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5748 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5749
5750 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5751 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5752 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5753 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5754 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5755 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5756 also issues a warning.
5757
5758 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5759 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5760 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5761 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5762 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5763 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5764
5765 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5766 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5767 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5768 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5769 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5770 details on specific languages.
5771
5772 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5773
5774 @kindex set check@r{, type}
5775 @kindex set check type
5776 @kindex show check type
5777 @table @code
5778 @item set check type auto
5779 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5780 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5781 each language.
5782
5783 @item set check type on
5784 @itemx set check type off
5785 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5786 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5787 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
5788 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
5789 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5790
5791 @item set check type warn
5792 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5793 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5794 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5795 numbers and structures.
5796
5797 @item show type
5798 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5799 is setting it automatically.
5800 @end table
5801
5802 @cindex range checking
5803 @cindex checks, range
5804 @node Range Checking
5805 @subsection An overview of range checking
5806
5807 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5808 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5809 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5810 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5811 not exceed the bounds of the array.
5812
5813 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5814 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5815 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5816 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5817
5818 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5819 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5820 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5821 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5822 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5823 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5824
5825 @example
5826 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5827 @end example
5828
5829 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5830 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5831 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5832
5833 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5834
5835 @kindex set check@r{, range}
5836 @kindex set check range
5837 @kindex show check range
5838 @table @code
5839 @item set check range auto
5840 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5841 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5842 each language.
5843
5844 @item set check range on
5845 @itemx set check range off
5846 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5847 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
5848 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5849 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5850
5851 @item set check range warn
5852 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5853 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5854 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5855 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5856 systems).
5857
5858 @item show range
5859 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5860 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5861 @end table
5862
5863 @node Support
5864 @section Supported languages
5865
5866 @value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5867 @c This is false ...
5868 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5869 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5870 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5871 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5872 language.
5873
5874 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5875 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5876 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5877 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5878 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5879 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5880 language reference or tutorial.
5881
5882 @menu
5883 * C:: C and C++
5884 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
5885 * Chill:: Chill
5886 @end menu
5887
5888 @node C
5889 @subsection C and C++
5890
5891 @cindex C and C++
5892 @cindex expressions in C or C++
5893
5894 Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5895 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5896 together.
5897
5898 @cindex C@t{++}
5899 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
5900 @cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5901 The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5902 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5903 effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5904 C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5905 compiler (@code{aCC}).
5906
5907 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5908 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5909 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5910 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5911 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
5912
5913 @menu
5914 * C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5915 * C Constants:: C and C++ constants
5916 * C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
5917 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
5918 * C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
5919 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5920 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5921 @end menu
5922
5923 @node C Operators
5924 @subsubsection C and C++ operators
5925
5926 @cindex C and C++ operators
5927
5928 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5929 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5930 often defined on groups of types.
5931
5932 For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
5933
5934 @itemize @bullet
5935
5936 @item
5937 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5938 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
5939
5940 @item
5941 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5942 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
5943
5944 @item
5945 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
5946
5947 @item
5948 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
5949
5950 @end itemize
5951
5952 @noindent
5953 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5954 in order of increasing precedence:
5955
5956 @table @code
5957 @item ,
5958 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5959 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5960 expression being the last expression evaluated.
5961
5962 @item =
5963 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5964 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5965
5966 @item @var{op}=
5967 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5968 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
5969 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
5970 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5971 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5972
5973 @item ?:
5974 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5975 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5976 integral type.
5977
5978 @item ||
5979 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5980
5981 @item &&
5982 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5983
5984 @item |
5985 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5986
5987 @item ^
5988 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5989
5990 @item &
5991 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5992
5993 @item ==@r{, }!=
5994 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5995 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5996
5997 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5998 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5999 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6000 and non-zero for true.
6001
6002 @item <<@r{, }>>
6003 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6004
6005 @item @@
6006 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6007
6008 @item +@r{, }-
6009 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6010 pointer types.
6011
6012 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6013 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6014 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6015 integral types.
6016
6017 @item ++@r{, }--
6018 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6019 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6020 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6021 operation takes place.
6022
6023 @item *
6024 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6025 @code{++}.
6026
6027 @item &
6028 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6029
6030 For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6031 allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6032 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6033 where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6034 stored.
6035
6036 @item -
6037 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6038 precedence as @code{++}.
6039
6040 @item !
6041 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6042 @code{++}.
6043
6044 @item ~
6045 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6046 @code{++}.
6047
6048
6049 @item .@r{, }->
6050 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6051 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6052 pointer based on the stored type information.
6053 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6054
6055 @item .*@r{, }->*
6056 Dereferences of pointers to members.
6057
6058 @item []
6059 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6060 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6061
6062 @item ()
6063 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6064
6065 @item ::
6066 C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6067 and @code{class} types.
6068
6069 @item ::
6070 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6071 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6072 above.
6073 @end table
6074
6075 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6076 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6077 predefined meaning.
6078
6079 @menu
6080 * C Constants::
6081 @end menu
6082
6083 @node C Constants
6084 @subsubsection C and C++ constants
6085
6086 @cindex C and C++ constants
6087
6088 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
6089 following ways:
6090
6091 @itemize @bullet
6092 @item
6093 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6094 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6095 a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6096 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6097 @code{long} value.
6098
6099 @item
6100 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6101 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6102 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6103 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6104 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
6105 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6106 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6107 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6108 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6109 constant.
6110
6111 @item
6112 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6113 integral equivalents.
6114
6115 @item
6116 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6117 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
6118 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
6119 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6120 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6121 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6122 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6123 @samp{\n} for newline.
6124
6125 @item
6126 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6127 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6128 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6129 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6130 characters.
6131
6132 @item
6133 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6134 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6135
6136 @item
6137 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6138 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6139 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6140 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6141 @end itemize
6142
6143 @menu
6144 * C plus plus expressions::
6145 * C Defaults::
6146 * C Checks::
6147
6148 * Debugging C::
6149 @end menu
6150
6151 @node C plus plus expressions
6152 @subsubsection C++ expressions
6153
6154 @cindex expressions in C++
6155 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6156
6157 @cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6158 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6159 @cindex C++ and object formats
6160 @cindex object formats and C++
6161 @cindex a.out and C++
6162 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6163 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6164 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6165 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6166 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6167 @c periodically whether this has happened...
6168 @quotation
6169 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6170 proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6171 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6172 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6173 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6174 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6175 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6176 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6177 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6178 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6179 @end quotation
6180
6181 @enumerate
6182
6183 @cindex member functions
6184 @item
6185 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6186
6187 @example
6188 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6189 @end example
6190
6191 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
6192 @cindex namespace in C++
6193 @item
6194 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6195 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6196 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6197 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6198
6199 @cindex call overloaded functions
6200 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
6201 @cindex type conversions in C++
6202 @item
6203 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
6204 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
6205 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6206 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6207 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6208 default arguments.
6209
6210 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6211 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6212 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6213 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6214 number of function arguments.
6215
6216 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6217 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6218 ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6219
6220 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
6221 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6222 @smallexample
6223 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6224 @end smallexample
6225
6226 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
6227 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
6228
6229 @cindex reference declarations
6230 @item
6231 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6232 them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6233 dereferenced.
6234
6235 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6236 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6237 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6238 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6239 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6240
6241 @item
6242 @value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6243 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6244 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6245 necessary, for example in an expression like
6246 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6247 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6248 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6249 @end enumerate
6250
6251 In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6252 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6253 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6254 invoking user-defined operators.
6255
6256 @node C Defaults
6257 @subsubsection C and C++ defaults
6258
6259 @cindex C and C++ defaults
6260
6261 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6262 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6263 C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6264 selects the working language.
6265
6266 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6267 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6268 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6269 these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6270 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6271 for further details.
6272
6273 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6274 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6275 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
6276
6277 @node C Checks
6278 @subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
6279
6280 @cindex C and C++ checks
6281
6282 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6283 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6284 considers two variables type equivalent if:
6285
6286 @itemize @bullet
6287 @item
6288 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6289 enumerated tag.
6290
6291 @item
6292 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6293 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6294
6295 @ignore
6296 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6297 @c FIXME--beers?
6298 @item
6299 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6300 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6301 compilers.)
6302 @end ignore
6303 @end itemize
6304
6305 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6306 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6307 that is not itself an array.
6308
6309 @node Debugging C
6310 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
6311
6312 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6313 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
6314 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6315 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
6316
6317 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6318 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6319 ,Expressions}.
6320
6321 @menu
6322 * Debugging C plus plus::
6323 @end menu
6324
6325 @node Debugging C plus plus
6326 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
6327
6328 @cindex commands for C++
6329
6330 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6331 designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6332
6333 @table @code
6334 @cindex break in overloaded functions
6335 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
6336 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6337 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6338 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6339
6340 @cindex overloading in C++
6341 @item rbreak @var{regex}
6342 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6343 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6344 classes.
6345 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6346
6347 @cindex C++ exception handling
6348 @item catch throw
6349 @itemx catch catch
6350 Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6351 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6352
6353 @cindex inheritance
6354 @item ptype @var{typename}
6355 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6356 @var{typename}.
6357 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6358
6359 @cindex C++ symbol display
6360 @item set print demangle
6361 @itemx show print demangle
6362 @itemx set print asm-demangle
6363 @itemx show print asm-demangle
6364 Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6365 displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6366 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6367
6368 @item set print object
6369 @itemx show print object
6370 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6371 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6372
6373 @item set print vtbl
6374 @itemx show print vtbl
6375 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6376 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6377 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6378 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6379
6380 @kindex set overload-resolution
6381 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
6382 @item set overload-resolution on
6383 Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6384 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6385 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
6386 using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6387 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
6388 message.
6389
6390 @item set overload-resolution off
6391 Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6392 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6393 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6394 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6395 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6396 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6397 argument types.
6398
6399 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6400 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6401 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6402 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6403 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6404 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6405 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6406 @end table
6407
6408 @node Modula-2
6409 @subsection Modula-2
6410
6411 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
6412
6413 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6414 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6415 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6416 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6417 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6418 table.
6419
6420 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
6421 @menu
6422 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6423 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6424 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6425 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6426 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6427 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6428 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6429 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6430 @end menu
6431
6432 @node M2 Operators
6433 @subsubsection Operators
6434 @cindex Modula-2 operators
6435
6436 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6437 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6438 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6439 following definitions hold:
6440
6441 @itemize @bullet
6442
6443 @item
6444 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6445 their subranges.
6446
6447 @item
6448 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6449
6450 @item
6451 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6452
6453 @item
6454 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6455 @var{type}}.
6456
6457 @item
6458 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6459
6460 @item
6461 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6462
6463 @item
6464 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6465 @end itemize
6466
6467 @noindent
6468 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6469 increasing precedence:
6470
6471 @table @code
6472 @item ,
6473 Function argument or array index separator.
6474
6475 @item :=
6476 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6477 @var{value}.
6478
6479 @item <@r{, }>
6480 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6481 types.
6482
6483 @item <=@r{, }>=
6484 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6485 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6486 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6487
6488 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6489 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6490 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6491 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6492 comment character.
6493
6494 @item IN
6495 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6496 Same precedence as @code{<}.
6497
6498 @item OR
6499 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6500
6501 @item AND@r{, }&
6502 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6503
6504 @item @@
6505 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6506
6507 @item +@r{, }-
6508 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6509 and difference on set types.
6510
6511 @item *
6512 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6513 on set types.
6514
6515 @item /
6516 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6517 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6518
6519 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
6520 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6521 precedence as @code{*}.
6522
6523 @item -
6524 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6525
6526 @item ^
6527 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6528
6529 @item NOT
6530 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6531 @code{^}.
6532
6533 @item .
6534 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6535 precedence as @code{^}.
6536
6537 @item []
6538 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6539
6540 @item ()
6541 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6542 as @code{^}.
6543
6544 @item ::@r{, }.
6545 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6546 @end table
6547
6548 @quotation
6549 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6550 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6551 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6552 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6553 @end quotation
6554
6555 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6556 @node Built-In Func/Proc
6557 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6558
6559 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6560 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6561
6562 @table @var
6563
6564 @item a
6565 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6566
6567 @item c
6568 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6569
6570 @item i
6571 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6572
6573 @item m
6574 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6575 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6576 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6577
6578 @item n
6579 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6580
6581 @item r
6582 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6583
6584 @item t
6585 represents a type.
6586
6587 @item v
6588 represents a variable.
6589
6590 @item x
6591 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6592 explanation of the function for details.
6593 @end table
6594
6595 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6596
6597 @table @code
6598 @item ABS(@var{n})
6599 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6600
6601 @item CAP(@var{c})
6602 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6603 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
6604
6605 @item CHR(@var{i})
6606 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6607
6608 @item DEC(@var{v})
6609 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
6610
6611 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6612 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6613 new value.
6614
6615 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6616 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6617 set.
6618
6619 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
6620 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6621
6622 @item HIGH(@var{a})
6623 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6624
6625 @item INC(@var{v})
6626 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
6627
6628 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6629 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6630 new value.
6631
6632 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6633 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6634 there. Returns the new set.
6635
6636 @item MAX(@var{t})
6637 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6638
6639 @item MIN(@var{t})
6640 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6641
6642 @item ODD(@var{i})
6643 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6644
6645 @item ORD(@var{x})
6646 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
6647 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6648 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6649 integral, character and enumerated types.
6650
6651 @item SIZE(@var{x})
6652 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6653
6654 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
6655 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6656
6657 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6658 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @quotation
6662 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6663 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6664 an error.
6665 @end quotation
6666
6667 @cindex Modula-2 constants
6668 @node M2 Constants
6669 @subsubsection Constants
6670
6671 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6672 ways:
6673
6674 @itemize @bullet
6675
6676 @item
6677 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6678 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6679 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6680 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6681
6682 @item
6683 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6684 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6685 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6686 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6687 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6688 digits.
6689
6690 @item
6691 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6692 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
6693 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
6694 followed by a @samp{C}.
6695
6696 @item
6697 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6698 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6699 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6700 Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6701 sequences.
6702
6703 @item
6704 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6705
6706 @item
6707 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6708 @code{FALSE}.
6709
6710 @item
6711 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6712
6713 @item
6714 Set constants are not yet supported.
6715 @end itemize
6716
6717 @node M2 Defaults
6718 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6719 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
6720
6721 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6722 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
6723 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6724 selected the working language.
6725
6726 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6727 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
6728 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
6729 the language automatically}, for further details.
6730
6731 @node Deviations
6732 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6733 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6734
6735 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6736 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6737
6738 @itemize @bullet
6739 @item
6740 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6741 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6742 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6743 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6744 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6745 returned a pointer.)
6746
6747 @item
6748 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6749 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6750 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6751 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6752
6753 @item
6754 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6755 argument.
6756
6757 @item
6758 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6759 @end itemize
6760
6761 @node M2 Checks
6762 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6763 @cindex Modula-2 checks
6764
6765 @quotation
6766 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6767 range checking.
6768 @end quotation
6769 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6770
6771 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6772
6773 @itemize @bullet
6774 @item
6775 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6776 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6777
6778 @item
6779 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6780 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6781 @end itemize
6782
6783 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6784 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6785
6786 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6787 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6788
6789 @node M2 Scope
6790 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6791 @cindex scope
6792 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
6793 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6794 @ifinfo
6795 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
6796 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6797 @end ifinfo
6798 @iftex
6799 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
6800 @end iftex
6801
6802 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6803 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6804 similar syntax:
6805
6806 @example
6807
6808 @var{module} . @var{id}
6809 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
6810 @end example
6811
6812 @noindent
6813 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6814 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6815 identifier within your program, except another module.
6816
6817 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6818 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6819 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6820 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6821
6822 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6823 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6824 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6825 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6826 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6827 @var{module}.
6828
6829 @node GDB/M2
6830 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6831
6832 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6833 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6834 specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6835 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6836 apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6837 analogue in Modula-2.
6838
6839 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
6840 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
6841 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6842 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6843 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
6844 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
6845
6846 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6847 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6848 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
6849
6850 @node Chill
6851 @subsection Chill
6852
6853 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
6854 from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
6855 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6856 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6857 table.
6858
6859 @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6860 @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6861 This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
6862 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6863
6864 @menu
6865 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6866 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
6867 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
6868 * Chill type and range checks::
6869 * Chill defaults::
6870 @end menu
6871
6872 @node How modes are displayed
6873 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
6874
6875 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
6876 with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
6877 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6878 provided modes are:
6879
6880 @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6881 @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
6882 @table @code
6883 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6884 @itemize @bullet
6885 @item
6886 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6887 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6888 @item
6889 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6890 @item
6891 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6892 @item
6893 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6894 @smallexample
6895 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6896 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6897 @end smallexample
6898 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6899 @item
6900 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
6901 @smallexample
6902 @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
6903 @end smallexample
6904 where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
6905 expression (e.g. set element names).
6906 @end itemize
6907
6908 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6909 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
6910 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
6911 @smallexample
6912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6913 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6914 @end smallexample
6915
6916 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6917 @itemize @bullet
6918 @item
6919 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
6920 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6921 @item
6922 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6923 @end itemize
6924
6925 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6926 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6927 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
6928 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6929 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
6930 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6931
6932 @ignore
6933 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6934 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6935 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6936 @end ignore
6937
6938 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6939 @itemize @bullet
6940 @item
6941 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
6942 @smallexample
6943 @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
6944 @end smallexample
6945 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6946 @item
6947 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
6948 @smallexample
6949 @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
6950 @end smallexample
6951 where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6952 @end itemize
6953
6954 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6955 @itemize @bullet
6956 @item
6957 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6958 @item
6959 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6960 @end itemize
6961
6962 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6963 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6964
6965 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6966 @itemize @bullet
6967 @item
6968 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
6969 @smallexample
6970 @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
6971 @end smallexample
6972 followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
6973 mode
6974 @item
6975 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
6976 @smallexample
6977 @code{BOOLS(<string
6978 length>)}
6979 @end smallexample
6980 @end itemize
6981
6982 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6983 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6984 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6985 @smallexample
6986 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6987 type = ARRAY (1:42)
6988 ARRAY (1:20)
6989 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6990 @end smallexample
6991
6992 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6993 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
6994 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6995 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6996 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
6997 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6998 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6999 always displays all variant fields.
7000 @smallexample
7001 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7002 type = STRUCT (
7003 as x,
7004 bs x,
7005 CASE bs OF
7006 (karli):
7007 cs a
7008 (ott):
7009 ds x
7010 ESAC
7011 )
7012 @end smallexample
7013 @end table
7014
7015 @node Locations
7016 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7017
7018 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7019
7020 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
7021 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7022 Chill programs. How values are specified
7023 is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
7024
7025 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7026 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
7027
7028 @smallexample
7029 set result := EXPR
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 @noindent
7033 This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
7034 is not available in @value{GDBN}).
7035
7036 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7037 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
7038 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
7039 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7040 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
7041 operator @samp{->}.
7042
7043 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7044 @smallexample
7045 @code{@{ PROC
7046 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
7047 location>}
7048 @end smallexample
7049 @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7050 specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7051 the entry point.
7052
7053 @ignore
7054 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7055 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7056 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
7057 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7058 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7059 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
7060 @code{__proc_copy}.
7061
7062 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7063 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7064 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7065 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7066
7067 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
7068 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
7069 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
7070 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7071 structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7072 braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
7073 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
7074 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
7075 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
7076 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
7077 stuff ???)
7078 @smallexample
7079 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7080 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7081 @end smallexample
7082 @end ignore
7083
7084 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7085 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
7086 certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7087 and their Operations}.
7088
7089 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
7090 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7091 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7092 have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7093 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
7094 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
7095
7096 @smallexample
7097 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7098 @end smallexample
7099
7100 @node Values and their Operations
7101 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
7102
7103 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7104 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
7105 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7106 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
7107 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
7108 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
7109 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7110 the values behind these locations.
7111
7112 This section describes how values have to be specified and which
7113 operations are legal to be used with such values.
7114
7115 @table @code
7116 @item Literal Values
7117 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7118 For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
7119 chapter 1.5.
7120 @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7121 @c be converted to a @ref.
7122
7123 @ignore
7124 @itemize @bullet
7125 @item
7126 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7127 programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
7128 @item
7129 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7130 @item
7131 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7132 @code{'M'})
7133 @item
7134 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
7135 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7136 comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
7137 @item
7138 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
7139 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7140 procedure value or the empty instance value.
7141
7142 @item
7143 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
7144 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
7145 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7146 @item
7147 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7148 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7149 @item
7150 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
7151 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
7152 @end itemize
7153 @end ignore
7154
7155 @item Tuple Values
7156 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
7157 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
7158 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7159 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
7160
7161 @itemize @bullet
7162 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7163 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
7164 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7165 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
7166 same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
7167 @end itemize
7168
7169 @item String Element Value
7170 A string element value is specified by
7171 @smallexample
7172 @code{<string value>(<index>)}
7173 @end smallexample
7174 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
7175 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7176 the string.
7177
7178 @item String Slice Value
7179 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7180 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7181 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7182 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7183 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7184 string.
7185
7186 @item Array Element Values
7187 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7188 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7189
7190 @item Array Slice Values
7191 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7192 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
7193 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7194 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
7195 which is part of the specified array.
7196
7197 @item Structure Field Values
7198 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
7199 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7200 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
7201 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7202
7203 @item Procedure Call Value
7204 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7205 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7206 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
7207 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
7208
7209 Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
7210
7211 Values of time mode locations appear as
7212 @smallexample
7213 @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7214 @end smallexample
7215
7216
7217 @ignore
7218 This is not implemented yet:
7219 @item Built-in Value
7220 @noindent
7221 The following built in functions are provided:
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @item @code{ADDR()}
7225 @item @code{NUM()}
7226 @item @code{PRED()}
7227 @item @code{SUCC()}
7228 @item @code{ABS()}
7229 @item @code{CARD()}
7230 @item @code{MAX()}
7231 @item @code{MIN()}
7232 @item @code{SIZE()}
7233 @item @code{UPPER()}
7234 @item @code{LOWER()}
7235 @item @code{LENGTH()}
7236 @item @code{SIN()}
7237 @item @code{COS()}
7238 @item @code{TAN()}
7239 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
7240 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
7241 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
7242 @item @code{EXP()}
7243 @item @code{LN()}
7244 @item @code{LOG()}
7245 @item @code{SQRT()}
7246 @end table
7247
7248 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7249 chapter 1.6.
7250 @end ignore
7251
7252 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
7253 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7254 current active process.
7255
7256 @item Expression Values
7257 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
7258 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
7259 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
7260 corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
7261 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
7262 which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
7263 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
7264
7265 @table @code
7266 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
7267 @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7268 @itemx @code{NOT}
7269 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
7270
7271 @item @code{=, /=}
7272 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
7273
7274 @item @code{>, >=}
7275 @itemx @code{<, <=}
7276 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
7277
7278 @item @code{+, -}
7279 @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
7280 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
7281
7282 @item @code{-}
7283 Change sign operator.
7284
7285 @item @code{//}
7286 String concatenation operator.
7287
7288 @item @code{()}
7289 String repetition operator.
7290
7291 @item @code{->}
7292 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7293 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7294 location (@code{loc->}).
7295
7296 @item @code{OR, XOR}
7297 @itemx @code{AND}
7298 @itemx @code{NOT}
7299 Powerset and bitstring operators.
7300
7301 @item @code{>, >=}
7302 @itemx @code{<, <=}
7303 Powerset inclusion operators.
7304
7305 @item @code{IN}
7306 Membership operator.
7307 @end table
7308 @end table
7309
7310 @node Chill type and range checks
7311 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7312
7313 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
7314 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
7315 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
7316 equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
7317 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7318
7319 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7320 index bounds and all built in procedures.
7321
7322 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
7323 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
7324 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7325 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7326 language specification.
7327
7328 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7329 off}.
7330
7331 @ignore
7332 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
7333 see last paragraph ?
7334 @end ignore
7335
7336 @node Chill defaults
7337 @subsubsection Chill defaults
7338
7339 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7340 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7341 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7342 selected the working language.
7343
7344 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7345 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
7346 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7347 the language automatically}, for further details.
7348
7349 @node Symbols
7350 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7351
7352 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
7353 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7354 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7355 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7356 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7357 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7358 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7359
7360 @cindex symbol names
7361 @cindex names of symbols
7362 @cindex quoting names
7363 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7364 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7365 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7366 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7367 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7368 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7369 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7370 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7371
7372 @example
7373 p 'foo.c'::x
7374 @end example
7375
7376 @noindent
7377 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7378
7379 @table @code
7380 @kindex info address
7381 @item info address @var{symbol}
7382 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7383 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7384 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7385 is always stored.
7386
7387 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7388 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7389 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7390
7391 @kindex whatis
7392 @item whatis @var{expr}
7393 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
7394 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7395 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7396 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7397
7398 @item whatis
7399 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7400
7401 @kindex ptype
7402 @item ptype @var{typename}
7403 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7404 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7405 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7406 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
7407
7408 @item ptype @var{expr}
7409 @itemx ptype
7410 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
7411 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7412 of just the name of the type.
7413
7414 For example, for this variable declaration:
7415
7416 @example
7417 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7418 @end example
7419
7420 @noindent
7421 the two commands give this output:
7422
7423 @example
7424 @group
7425 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7426 type = struct complex
7427 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7428 type = struct complex @{
7429 double real;
7430 double imag;
7431 @}
7432 @end group
7433 @end example
7434
7435 @noindent
7436 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7437 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7438
7439 @kindex info types
7440 @item info types @var{regexp}
7441 @itemx info types
7442 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
7443 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7444 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7445 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
7446 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
7447 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7448
7449 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7450 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7451 lists all source files where a type is defined.
7452
7453 @kindex info source
7454 @item info source
7455 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7456 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7457 it was written in.
7458
7459 @kindex info sources
7460 @item info sources
7461 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7462 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7463 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7464
7465 @kindex info functions
7466 @item info functions
7467 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7468
7469 @item info functions @var{regexp}
7470 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7471 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7472 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7473 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7474 start with @code{step}.
7475
7476 @kindex info variables
7477 @item info variables
7478 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7479 outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7480
7481 @item info variables @var{regexp}
7482 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7483 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7484 @var{regexp}.
7485
7486 @ignore
7487 This was never implemented.
7488 @kindex info methods
7489 @item info methods
7490 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7491 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7492 methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7493 specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7494 C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7495 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7496 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7497 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7498 @end ignore
7499
7500 @cindex reloading symbols
7501 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7502 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7503 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7504 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7505 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
7506
7507 @table @code
7508 @kindex set symbol-reloading
7509 @item set symbol-reloading on
7510 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7511 object file with a particular name is seen again.
7512
7513 @item set symbol-reloading off
7514 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7515 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
7516 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7517 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7518 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7519 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7520 name.
7521
7522 @kindex show symbol-reloading
7523 @item show symbol-reloading
7524 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7525 @end table
7526
7527 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7528 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
7529 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7530 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7531 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7532 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7533 another source file. The default is on.
7534
7535 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7536 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7537
7538 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
7539 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7540 is printed as follows:
7541 @smallexample
7542 @{<no data fields>@}
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7546 @item show opaque-type-resolution
7547 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
7548
7549 @kindex maint print symbols
7550 @cindex symbol dump
7551 @kindex maint print psymbols
7552 @cindex partial symbol dump
7553 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7554 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7555 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7556 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7557 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7558 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7559 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7560 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7561 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7562 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7563 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7564 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7565 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7566 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7567 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7568 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7569 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7570 @end table
7571
7572 @node Altering
7573 @chapter Altering Execution
7574
7575 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7576 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7577 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7578 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7579 program.
7580
7581 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7582 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7583 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
7584
7585 @menu
7586 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7587 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
7588 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
7589 * Returning:: Returning from a function
7590 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7591 * Patching:: Patching your program
7592 @end menu
7593
7594 @node Assignment
7595 @section Assignment to variables
7596
7597 @cindex assignment
7598 @cindex setting variables
7599 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7600 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7601
7602 @example
7603 print x=4
7604 @end example
7605
7606 @noindent
7607 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7608 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
7609 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7610 information on operators in supported languages.
7611
7612 @kindex set variable
7613 @cindex variables, setting
7614 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7615 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7616 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7617 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7618 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7619
7620 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7621 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7622 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7623 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7624 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7625 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7626 command @code{set width}:
7627
7628 @example
7629 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7630 type = double
7631 (@value{GDBP}) p width
7632 $4 = 13
7633 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7634 Invalid syntax in expression.
7635 @end example
7636
7637 @noindent
7638 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7639 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7640
7641 @example
7642 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7643 @end example
7644
7645 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7646 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7647 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7648 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7649 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7650 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7651
7652 @example
7653 @group
7654 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7655 type = double
7656 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7657 $1 = 1
7658 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
7659 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7660 $2 = 1
7661 (@value{GDBP}) r
7662 The program being debugged has been started already.
7663 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7664 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7665 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7666 Invalid bfd target.
7667 (@value{GDBP}) show g
7668 The current BFD target is "=4".
7669 @end group
7670 @end example
7671
7672 @noindent
7673 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7674 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7675 @code{g}, use
7676
7677 @example
7678 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7679 @end example
7680
7681 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7682 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7683 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7684 same length or shorter.
7685 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7686 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7687
7688 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7689 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7690 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7691 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7692 and representation in memory), and
7693
7694 @example
7695 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7696 @end example
7697
7698 @noindent
7699 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7700
7701 @node Jumping
7702 @section Continuing at a different address
7703
7704 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7705 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7706 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7707
7708 @table @code
7709 @kindex jump
7710 @item jump @var{linespec}
7711 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7712 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7713 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7714 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7715 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7716 breakpoints}.
7717
7718 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7719 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7720 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7721 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7722 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7723 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7724 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7725 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7726 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7727
7728 @item jump *@var{address}
7729 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7730 @end table
7731
7732 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
7733 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7734 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7735 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7736 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7737 example,
7738
7739 @example
7740 set $pc = 0x485
7741 @end example
7742
7743 @noindent
7744 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7745 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7746 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
7747
7748 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7749 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7750 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7751 detail.
7752
7753 @c @group
7754 @node Signaling
7755 @section Giving your program a signal
7756
7757 @table @code
7758 @kindex signal
7759 @item signal @var{signal}
7760 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7761 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7762 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7763 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7764
7765 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7766 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7767 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7768 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7769 signal.
7770
7771 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7772 after executing the command.
7773 @end table
7774 @c @end group
7775
7776 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7777 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7778 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7779 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7780 passes the signal directly to your program.
7781
7782
7783 @node Returning
7784 @section Returning from a function
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @cindex returning from a function
7788 @kindex return
7789 @item return
7790 @itemx return @var{expression}
7791 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7792 command. If you give an
7793 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7794 value.
7795 @end table
7796
7797 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7798 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7799 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7800 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7801
7802 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7803 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7804 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7805 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7806 of functions.
7807
7808 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7809 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7810 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7811 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7812 selected stack frame returns naturally.
7813
7814 @node Calling
7815 @section Calling program functions
7816
7817 @cindex calling functions
7818 @kindex call
7819 @table @code
7820 @item call @var{expr}
7821 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7822 returned values.
7823 @end table
7824
7825 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7826 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7827 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7828 is printed and saved in the value history.
7829
7830 For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7831 specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7832 calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7833 method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7834 that have separate instruction and data spaces.
7835
7836 @node Patching
7837 @section Patching programs
7838
7839 @cindex patching binaries
7840 @cindex writing into executables
7841 @cindex writing into corefiles
7842
7843 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7844 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7845 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7846 patching your program's binary.
7847
7848 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7849 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7850 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7851 repairs.
7852
7853 @table @code
7854 @kindex set write
7855 @item set write on
7856 @itemx set write off
7857 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7858 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
7859 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7860
7861 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7862 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7863 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
7864
7865 @item show write
7866 @kindex show write
7867 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7868 as well as reading.
7869 @end table
7870
7871 @node GDB Files
7872 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7873
7874 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7875 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7876 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7877 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
7878
7879 @menu
7880 * Files:: Commands to specify files
7881 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7882 @end menu
7883
7884 @node Files
7885 @section Commands to specify files
7886
7887 @cindex symbol table
7888 @cindex core dump file
7889
7890 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7891 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7892 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7893 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
7894
7895 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7896 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7897 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7898 to specify new files are useful.
7899
7900 @table @code
7901 @cindex executable file
7902 @kindex file
7903 @item file @var{filename}
7904 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7905 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7906 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7907 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7908 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7909 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7910 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7911 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7912
7913 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
7914 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7915 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7916 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7917 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7918 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7919 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7920 for more information.
7921
7922 @item file
7923 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7924 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7925
7926 @kindex exec-file
7927 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7928 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7929 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7930 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7931 discard information on the executable file.
7932
7933 @kindex symbol-file
7934 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7935 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7936 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7937 table and program to run from the same file.
7938
7939 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7940 program's symbol table.
7941
7942 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7943 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7944 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7945 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7946 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7947
7948 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7949 executing it once.
7950
7951 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7952 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7953 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7954 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
7955 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7956 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7957 optimized code.
7958
7959 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7960 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7961 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7962 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7963 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7964
7965 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7966 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7967 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7968 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7969 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7970 warnings and messages}.)
7971
7972 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7973 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7974 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7975 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7976 in stabs format.
7977
7978 @kindex readnow
7979 @cindex reading symbols immediately
7980 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
7981 @kindex mapped
7982 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7983 @cindex saving symbol table
7984 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7985 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7986 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7987 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7988 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7989 entire symbol table available.
7990
7991 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7992 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7993 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7994 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7995 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7996 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7997 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7998 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7999
8000 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8001 file has all the symbol information for your program.
8002
8003 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8004 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8005 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8006 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8007 needed.
8008
8009 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8010 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8011 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
8012
8013 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8014 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8015 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8016 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8017 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8018 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8019 @c files.
8020
8021 @kindex core
8022 @kindex core-file
8023 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8024 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8025 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8026 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8027 executable file itself for other parts.
8028
8029 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8030 to be used.
8031
8032 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
8033 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8034 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8035 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
8036 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
8037
8038 @kindex add-symbol-file
8039 @cindex dynamic linking
8040 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8041 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8042 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
8043 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8044 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8045 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8046 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8047 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
8048 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8049 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8050 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8051 @var{address} as an expression.
8052
8053 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8054 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
8055 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8056 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8057 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
8058
8059 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8060
8061 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8062 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8063 table information for @var{filename}.
8064
8065 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8066 @item add-shared-symbol-file
8067 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
8068 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8069 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
8070 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
8071
8072 @kindex section
8073 @item section
8074 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8075 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8076 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8077 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
8078 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8079 the sections and their addresses.
8080
8081 @kindex info files
8082 @kindex info target
8083 @item info files
8084 @itemx info target
8085 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8086 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8087 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8088 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8089 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8090 current ones.
8091
8092 @end table
8093
8094 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8095 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8096 name and remembers it that way.
8097
8098 @cindex shared libraries
8099 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8100 libraries.
8101
8102 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8103 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8104 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8105 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8106 debugging a core file).
8107
8108 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8109 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8110
8111 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8112 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8113 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8114
8115 @table @code
8116 @kindex info sharedlibrary
8117 @kindex info share
8118 @item info share
8119 @itemx info sharedlibrary
8120 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8121
8122 @kindex sharedlibrary
8123 @kindex share
8124 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8125 @itemx share @var{regex}
8126 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8127 Unix regular expression.
8128 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8129 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8130 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8131 loaded.
8132 @end table
8133
8134 On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8135 and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8136 a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
8137
8138 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
8139 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8140 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
8141 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8142
8143 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8144
8145 @table @code
8146 @kindex set auto-solib-add
8147 @item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8148 Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8149 nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8150 automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8151 linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8152 the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8153 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8154 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8155
8156 @kindex show auto-solib-add
8157 @item show auto-solib-add
8158 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8159 @end table
8160
8161 @node Symbol Errors
8162 @section Errors reading symbol files
8163
8164 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8165 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8166 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8167 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8168 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8169 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8170 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8171 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8172 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8173 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8174 messages}).
8175
8176 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8177
8178 @table @code
8179 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8180
8181 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8182 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8183 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8184 in its outer scope blocks.
8185
8186 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8187 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8188 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8189 function.
8190
8191 @item block at @var{address} out of order
8192
8193 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8194 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8195 do so.
8196
8197 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8198 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8199 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8200 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8201 messages}.)
8202
8203 @item bad block start address patched
8204
8205 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8206 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8207 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8208
8209 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8210 starting on the previous source line.
8211
8212 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8213
8214 @cindex foo
8215 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8216 larger than the size of the string table.
8217
8218 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8219 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8220 with this name.
8221
8222 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8223
8224 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8225 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
8226 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
8227
8228 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8229 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
8230 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
8231 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8232 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8233 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
8234
8235 @item stub type has NULL name
8236
8237 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
8238
8239 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
8240 The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
8241 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8242 it.
8243
8244 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8245
8246 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
8247
8248 @end table
8249
8250 @node Targets
8251 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
8252
8253 @cindex debugging target
8254 @kindex target
8255
8256 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
8257
8258 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8259 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8260 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
8261 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8262 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
8263 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8264 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8265 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
8266
8267 @menu
8268 * Active Targets:: Active targets
8269 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
8270 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8271 * Remote:: Remote debugging
8272 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
8273
8274 @end menu
8275
8276 @node Active Targets
8277 @section Active targets
8278
8279 @cindex stacking targets
8280 @cindex active targets
8281 @cindex multiple targets
8282
8283 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
8284 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8285 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8286 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8287 a core file.
8288
8289 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8290 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8291 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8292 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8293 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8294 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8295 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8296 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8297 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
8298
8299 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
8300 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8301 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8302 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8303 process target is active.
8304
8305 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8306 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
8307 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
8308 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8309 process}).
8310
8311 @node Target Commands
8312 @section Commands for managing targets
8313
8314 @table @code
8315 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
8316 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8317 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8318 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8319 protocol of the target machine.
8320
8321 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8322 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8323 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
8324
8325 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8326 after executing the command.
8327
8328 @kindex help target
8329 @item help target
8330 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8331 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8332 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8333
8334 @item help target @var{name}
8335 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8336 select it.
8337
8338 @kindex set gnutarget
8339 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
8340 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8341 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8342 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8343 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8344 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8345
8346 @quotation
8347 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8348 you must know the actual BFD name.
8349 @end quotation
8350
8351 @noindent
8352 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
8353
8354 @kindex show gnutarget
8355 @item show gnutarget
8356 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8357 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8358 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8359 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8360 @end table
8361
8362 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8363 configuration):
8364
8365 @table @code
8366 @kindex target exec
8367 @item target exec @var{program}
8368 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8369 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8370
8371 @kindex target core
8372 @item target core @var{filename}
8373 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8374 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
8375
8376 @kindex target remote
8377 @item target remote @var{dev}
8378 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8379 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8380 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
8381 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
8382 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8383 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8384
8385 @kindex target sim
8386 @item target sim
8387 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
8388 In general,
8389 @example
8390 target sim
8391 load
8392 run
8393 @end example
8394 @noindent
8395 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
8396 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
8397 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8398 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8399 Processors}.
8400
8401 @end table
8402
8403 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
8404
8405 @table @code
8406
8407 @kindex target nrom
8408 @item target nrom @var{dev}
8409 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8410
8411 @end table
8412
8413 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8414 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
8415
8416 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8417 once you've successfully established a connection.
8418
8419 @table @code
8420
8421 @kindex load @var{filename}
8422 @item load @var{filename}
8423 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8424 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8425 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8426 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8427 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8428 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8429
8430 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8431 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8432 target is @dots{}}''
8433
8434 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8435 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8436 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8437 specifies a fixed address.
8438 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8439
8440 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8441 @end table
8442
8443 @node Byte Order
8444 @section Choosing target byte order
8445
8446 @cindex choosing target byte order
8447 @cindex target byte order
8448
8449 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8450 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8451 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8452 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8453 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
8454 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
8455
8456 @table @code
8457 @kindex set endian big
8458 @item set endian big
8459 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8460
8461 @kindex set endian little
8462 @item set endian little
8463 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8464
8465 @kindex set endian auto
8466 @item set endian auto
8467 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8468 executable.
8469
8470 @item show endian
8471 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8472
8473 @end table
8474
8475 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8476 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8477 target system.
8478
8479 @node Remote
8480 @section Remote debugging
8481 @cindex remote debugging
8482
8483 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8484 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8485 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8486 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8487 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8488
8489 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8490 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8491 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8492 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8493 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8494 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8495
8496 Other remote targets may be available in your
8497 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
8498
8499 @menu
8500 * Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8501 @end menu
8502
8503 @node Remote Serial
8504 @subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8505
8506 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8507 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8508 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8509 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8510 program, you need:
8511
8512 @enumerate
8513 @item
8514 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8515 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8516 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
8517
8518 @item
8519 A C subroutine library to support your program's
8520 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
8521
8522 @item
8523 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8524 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8525 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8526 documentation.
8527 @end enumerate
8528
8529 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8530 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8531 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
8532
8533 @table @emph
8534 @item On the host,
8535 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8536 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8537 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8538
8539 @item On the target,
8540 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8541 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8542 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8543
8544 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8545 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8546 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8547 @end table
8548
8549 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8550 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8551 @sc{sparc} boards.
8552
8553 @cindex remote serial stub list
8554 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
8555
8556 @table @code
8557
8558 @item i386-stub.c
8559 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
8560 @cindex Intel
8561 @cindex i386
8562 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8563
8564 @item m68k-stub.c
8565 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
8566 @cindex Motorola 680x0
8567 @cindex m680x0
8568 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8569
8570 @item sh-stub.c
8571 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
8572 @cindex Hitachi
8573 @cindex SH
8574 For Hitachi SH architectures.
8575
8576 @item sparc-stub.c
8577 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
8578 @cindex Sparc
8579 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8580
8581 @item sparcl-stub.c
8582 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
8583 @cindex Fujitsu
8584 @cindex SparcLite
8585 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8586
8587 @end table
8588
8589 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8590 recently added stubs.
8591
8592 @menu
8593 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8594 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8595 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8596 * Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8597 * Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8598 * NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8599 @end menu
8600
8601 @node Stub Contents
8602 @subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8603
8604 @cindex remote serial stub
8605 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8606 subroutines:
8607
8608 @table @code
8609 @item set_debug_traps
8610 @kindex set_debug_traps
8611 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8612 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8613 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8614 beginning of your program.
8615
8616 @item handle_exception
8617 @kindex handle_exception
8618 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8619 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8620 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8621 run when a trap is triggered.
8622
8623 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8624 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8625 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8626 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
8627 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
8628 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8629 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8630 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8631 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8632 machine.
8633
8634 @item breakpoint
8635 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8636 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8637 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8638 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8639 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8640 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8641 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8642 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8643 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8644 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8645 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
8646
8647 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8648 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8649 start of your debugging session.
8650 @end table
8651
8652 @node Bootstrapping
8653 @subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8654
8655 @cindex remote stub, support routines
8656 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8657 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8658 debugging target machine.
8659
8660 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8661 serial port.
8662
8663 @table @code
8664 @item int getDebugChar()
8665 @kindex getDebugChar
8666 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8667 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8668 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8669
8670 @item void putDebugChar(int)
8671 @kindex putDebugChar
8672 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8673 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8674 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8675 @end table
8676
8677 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
8678 @cindex interrupting remote targets
8679 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8680 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8681 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8682 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8683 remote system to stop.
8684
8685 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8686 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8687 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8688 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8689
8690 Other routines you need to supply are:
8691
8692 @table @code
8693 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8694 @kindex exceptionHandler
8695 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8696 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8697 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8698 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8699 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8700 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8701 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8702 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8703 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8704 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8705 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8706 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8707 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8708
8709 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8710 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8711 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8712 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8713 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8714
8715 @item void flush_i_cache()
8716 @kindex flush_i_cache
8717 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
8718 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8719 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8720
8721 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8722 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8723 @end table
8724
8725 @noindent
8726 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8727
8728 @table @code
8729 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8730 @kindex memset
8731 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8732 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8733 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8734 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8735 @end table
8736
8737 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8738 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8739 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
8740 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
8741
8742
8743 @node Debug Session
8744 @subsubsection Putting it all together
8745
8746 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
8747 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8748 steps.
8749
8750 @enumerate
8751 @item
8752 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
8753 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8754 @display
8755 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8756 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8757 @end display
8758
8759 @item
8760 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8761
8762 @example
8763 set_debug_traps();
8764 breakpoint();
8765 @end example
8766
8767 @item
8768 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8769 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8770
8771 @example
8772 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8773 @end example
8774
8775 @noindent
8776 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
8777 function in your program, that function is called when
8778 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8779 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8780 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8781
8782 @item
8783 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8784 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8785
8786 @item
8787 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8788 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8789
8790 @item
8791 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8792 @c document that. FIXME.
8793 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8794 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8795
8796 @item
8797 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8798 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8799 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8800 of its pure text.
8801
8802 @item
8803 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
8804 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
8805 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8806 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8807 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8808 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8809 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8810
8811 @example
8812 target remote /dev/ttyb
8813 @end example
8814
8815 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8816 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8817 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8818 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8819
8820 @example
8821 target remote manyfarms:2828
8822 @end example
8823 @end enumerate
8824
8825 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8826 step and continue the remote program.
8827
8828 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8829 command.
8830
8831 @cindex interrupting remote programs
8832 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
8833 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8834 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8835 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8836 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8837 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8838
8839 @example
8840 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8841 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8842 @end example
8843
8844 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8845 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8846 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8847 goes back to waiting.
8848
8849 @node Protocol
8850 @subsubsection Communication protocol
8851
8852 @cindex debugging stub, example
8853 @cindex remote stub, example
8854 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
8855 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8856 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8857 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8858 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8859 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8860 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8861 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8862
8863 However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8864 the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8865 target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8866 it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8867
8868 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8869 transmitted and received data respectfully.
8870
8871 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8872 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8873 @cindex remote serial protocol
8874 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
8875 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
8876 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
8877 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
8878
8879 @example
8880 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8881 @end example
8882 @noindent
8883
8884 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8885 @noindent
8886 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8887 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
8888 eight bit unsigned checksum).
8889
8890 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
8891 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
8892
8893 @example
8894 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8895 @end example
8896
8897 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8898 @noindent
8899 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
8900 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
8901 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
8902
8903 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
8904 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8905 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8906 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8907 retransmission):
8908
8909 @example
8910 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8911 -> @code{+}
8912 @end example
8913 @noindent
8914
8915 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8916 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8917 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8918 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8919
8920 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8921 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
8922 exceptions).
8923
8924 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
8925 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
8926 HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
8927
8928 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
8929 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
8930 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
8931
8932 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
8933 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
8934 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8935 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
8936 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8937 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8938 value greater than 126 should not be used.
8939
8940 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8941 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8942 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
8943
8944 So:
8945 @example
8946 "@code{0* }"
8947 @end example
8948 @noindent
8949 means the same as "0000".
8950
8951 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
8952 error number. That number is not well defined.
8953
8954 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8955 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8956 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
8957 on that response.
8958
8959 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
8960 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
8961 optional.
8962
8963 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8964 their corresponding response @var{data}:
8965 @page
8966 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8967 @item Packet
8968 @tab Request
8969 @tab Description
8970
8971 @item extended ops
8972 @tab @code{!}
8973 @tab
8974 Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
8975 The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
8976 @item
8977 @tab reply @samp{}
8978 @tab
8979 Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8980 unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8981 support protocol extensions.
8982
8983 @item last signal
8984 @tab @code{?}
8985 @tab
8986 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8987 and continue.
8988 @item
8989 @tab reply
8990 @tab see below
8991
8992
8993 @item reserved
8994 @tab @code{a}
8995 @tab Reserved for future use
8996
8997 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
8998 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8999 @tab
9000 @item
9001 @tab
9002 @tab
9003 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9004 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
9005 See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
9006 @item
9007 @tab reply @code{OK}
9008 @item
9009 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9010
9011 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9012 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9013 @tab
9014 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9015 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9016 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9017 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9018 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9019 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9020 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9021 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9022 happened.}
9023
9024 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9025 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9026 @tab
9027 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9028 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9029 @samp{z} packets.}
9030
9031 @item continue
9032 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9033 @tab
9034 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9035 current address.
9036 @item
9037 @tab reply
9038 @tab see below
9039
9040 @item continue with signal
9041 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9042 @tab
9043 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9044 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9045 @item
9046 @tab reply
9047 @tab see below
9048
9049 @item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
9050 @tab @code{d}
9051 @tab
9052 toggle debug flag.
9053
9054 @item detach
9055 @tab @code{D}
9056 @tab
9057 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9058 @value{GDBN} disconnects.
9059 @item
9060 @tab reply @emph{no response}
9061 @tab
9062 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
9063
9064 @item reserved
9065 @tab @code{e}
9066 @tab Reserved for future use
9067
9068 @item reserved
9069 @tab @code{E}
9070 @tab Reserved for future use
9071
9072 @item reserved
9073 @tab @code{f}
9074 @tab Reserved for future use
9075
9076 @item reserved
9077 @tab @code{F}
9078 @tab Reserved for future use
9079
9080 @item read registers
9081 @tab @code{g}
9082 @tab Read general registers.
9083 @item
9084 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9085 @tab
9086 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9087 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
9088 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
9089 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
9090 @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9091 @code{g} packets is specified below.
9092 @item
9093 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9094 @tab for an error.
9095
9096 @item write regs
9097 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9098 @tab
9099 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9100 @item
9101 @tab reply @code{OK}
9102 @tab for success
9103 @item
9104 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9105 @tab for an error
9106
9107 @item reserved
9108 @tab @code{h}
9109 @tab Reserved for future use
9110
9111 @item set thread
9112 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9113 @tab
9114 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9115 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9116 continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9117 thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
9118 @item
9119 @tab reply @code{OK}
9120 @tab for success
9121 @item
9122 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9123 @tab for an error
9124
9125 @c FIXME: JTC:
9126 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
9127 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
9128 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9129 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9130 @c described. For example:
9131 @c
9132 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9133 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9134 @c otherwise returns current registers.
9135 @c
9136 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9137 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9138 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9139
9140 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
9141 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9142 @tab
9143 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9144 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9145 step starting at that address.
9146
9147 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
9148 @tab @code{I}
9149 @tab
9150 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9151
9152 @item reserved
9153 @tab @code{j}
9154 @tab Reserved for future use
9155
9156 @item reserved
9157 @tab @code{J}
9158 @tab Reserved for future use
9159
9160 @item kill request
9161 @tab @code{k}
9162 @tab
9163 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9164 thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
9165
9166 @item reserved
9167 @tab @code{l}
9168 @tab Reserved for future use
9169
9170 @item reserved
9171 @tab @code{L}
9172 @tab Reserved for future use
9173
9174 @item read memory
9175 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9176 @tab
9177 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9178 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
9179 using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9180 transfer mechanism is needed.}
9181 @item
9182 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9183 @tab
9184 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
9185 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
9186 sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9187 @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
9188 @item
9189 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9190 @tab @var{NN} is errno
9191
9192 @item write mem
9193 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9194 @tab
9195 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9196 @var{XX...} is the data.
9197 @item
9198 @tab reply @code{OK}
9199 @tab for success
9200 @item
9201 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9202 @tab
9203 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9204 written).
9205
9206 @item reserved
9207 @tab @code{n}
9208 @tab Reserved for future use
9209
9210 @item reserved
9211 @tab @code{N}
9212 @tab Reserved for future use
9213
9214 @item reserved
9215 @tab @code{o}
9216 @tab Reserved for future use
9217
9218 @item reserved
9219 @tab @code{O}
9220 @tab Reserved for future use
9221
9222 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9223 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9224 @tab
9225 See write register.
9226 @item
9227 @tab return @var{r....}
9228 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9229
9230 @item write reg
9231 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9232 @tab
9233 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9234 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9235 @item
9236 @tab reply @code{OK}
9237 @tab for success
9238 @item
9239 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9240 @tab for an error
9241
9242 @item general query
9243 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
9244 @tab
9245 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
9246 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
9247 company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9248 optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9249 must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
9250 @item
9251 @tab reply @code{XX...}
9252 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
9253 @item
9254 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9255 @tab error reply
9256 @item
9257 @tab reply @samp{}
9258 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9259
9260 @item general set
9261 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9262 @tab
9263 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9264 naming conventions.
9265
9266 @item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
9267 @tab @code{r}
9268 @tab
9269 Reset the entire system.
9270
9271 @item remote restart
9272 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9273 @tab
9274 Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9275 definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9276 packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
9277
9278 @item step
9279 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9280 @tab
9281 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9282 same address.
9283 @item
9284 @tab reply
9285 @tab see below
9286
9287 @item step with signal
9288 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9289 @tab
9290 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9291 @item
9292 @tab reply
9293 @tab see below
9294
9295 @item search
9296 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9297 @tab
9298 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9299 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
9300 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
9301
9302 @item thread alive
9303 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9304 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9305 @item
9306 @tab reply @code{OK}
9307 @tab thread is still alive
9308 @item
9309 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9310 @tab thread is dead
9311
9312 @item reserved
9313 @tab @code{u}
9314 @tab Reserved for future use
9315
9316 @item reserved
9317 @tab @code{U}
9318 @tab Reserved for future use
9319
9320 @item reserved
9321 @tab @code{v}
9322 @tab Reserved for future use
9323
9324 @item reserved
9325 @tab @code{V}
9326 @tab Reserved for future use
9327
9328 @item reserved
9329 @tab @code{w}
9330 @tab Reserved for future use
9331
9332 @item reserved
9333 @tab @code{W}
9334 @tab Reserved for future use
9335
9336 @item reserved
9337 @tab @code{x}
9338 @tab Reserved for future use
9339
9340 @item write mem (binary)
9341 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9342 @tab
9343 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
9344 binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9345 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
9346 @item
9347 @tab reply @code{OK}
9348 @tab for success
9349 @item
9350 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9351 @tab for an error
9352
9353 @item reserved
9354 @tab @code{y}
9355 @tab Reserved for future use
9356
9357 @item reserved
9358 @tab @code{Y}
9359 @tab Reserved for future use
9360
9361 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
9362 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9363 @tab
9364 See @samp{Z}.
9365
9366 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
9367 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9368 @tab
9369 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9370 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9371 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9372 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9373 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
9374 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9375 potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9376 implemented in an idempotent way.
9377 @item
9378 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9379 @tab for an error
9380 @item
9381 @tab reply @code{OK}
9382 @tab for success
9383 @item
9384 @tab @samp{}
9385 @tab If not supported.
9386
9387 @item reserved
9388 @tab <other>
9389 @tab Reserved for future use
9390
9391 @end multitable
9392
9393 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9394 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9395 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9396 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9397 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9398 conventions is used.
9399
9400 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9401
9402 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
9403 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9404
9405 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9406 @tab
9407 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9408 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9409 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9410 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
9411 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
9412 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9413 extend the protocol.
9414
9415 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
9416 @tab
9417 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9418 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9419
9420 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
9421 @tab
9422 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9423
9424 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
9425 @tab
9426 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9427 @var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9428 @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
9429 this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9430 spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9431 debugger.}
9432
9433 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9434 @tab
9435 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
9436 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9437 for 'W', 'T', etc.
9438
9439 @end multitable
9440
9441 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9442
9443 @multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9444
9445 @item current thread
9446 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
9447 @tab Return the current thread id.
9448 @item
9449 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9450 @tab
9451 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9452 @item
9453 @tab reply *
9454 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9455
9456 @item all thread ids
9457 @tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9458 @item
9459 @tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
9460 @tab
9461 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9462 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9463 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9464 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
9465 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
9466 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
9467 @item
9468 @tab
9469 @tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
9470 @item
9471 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
9472 @tab A single thread id
9473 @item
9474 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
9475 @tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9476 @item
9477 @tab reply @code{l}
9478 @tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9479 @item
9480 @tab
9481 @tab
9482 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9483 or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9484 respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9485 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9486 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9487
9488 @item extra thread info
9489 @tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
9490 @tab
9491 @item
9492 @tab
9493 @tab
9494 Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9495 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9496 the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9497 thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9498 The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
9499 Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
9500 "Blocked on Mutex".
9501 @item
9502 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9503 @tab
9504 Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9505 printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9506 attributes.
9507
9508 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9509 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9510 @tab
9511 @item
9512 @tab
9513 @tab
9514 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9515 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9516 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9517 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9518 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9519 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9520 @item
9521 @tab
9522 @tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9523 query (see above).
9524 @item
9525 @tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9526 @tab
9527 @item
9528 @tab
9529 @tab
9530 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9531 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9532 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9533 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9534 a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9535 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9536
9537 @item compute CRC of memory block
9538 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9539 @tab
9540 @item
9541 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9542 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
9543 @item
9544 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9545 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9546
9547 @item query sect offs
9548 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
9549 @tab
9550 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9551 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9552 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9553 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
9554 @item
9555 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9556
9557 @item thread info request
9558 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9559 @tab
9560 @item
9561 @tab
9562 @tab
9563 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9564 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9565 @item
9566 @tab reply *
9567 @tab
9568 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9569
9570 @item remote command
9571 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9572 @tab
9573 @item
9574 @tab
9575 @tab
9576 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9577 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9578 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9579 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9580 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9581 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9582 @item
9583 @tab reply @code{OK}
9584 @tab
9585 A command response with no output.
9586 @item
9587 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9588 @tab
9589 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9590 @item
9591 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9592 @tab
9593 Indicate a badly formed request.
9594
9595 @item
9596 @tab reply @samp{}
9597 @tab
9598 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9599
9600 @end multitable
9601
9602 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9603 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9604 bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9605 space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9606 The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9607 least-significant.
9608
9609 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9610
9611 @item MIPS32
9612 @tab
9613 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
9614 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9615 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9616
9617 @item MIPS64
9618 @tab
9619 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9620 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9621 as @code{MIPS32}.
9622
9623 @end multitable
9624
9625 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9626 does not get any direct output:
9627
9628 @example
9629 <- @code{R00}
9630 -> @code{+}
9631 @emph{target restarts}
9632 <- @code{?}
9633 -> @code{+}
9634 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9635 <- @code{+}
9636 @end example
9637
9638 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9639
9640 @example
9641 <- @code{G1445...}
9642 -> @code{+}
9643 <- @code{s}
9644 -> @code{+}
9645 @emph{time passes}
9646 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9647 <- @code{+}
9648 <- @code{g}
9649 -> @code{+}
9650 -> @code{1455...}
9651 <- @code{+}
9652 @end example
9653
9654 @node Server
9655 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9656
9657 @kindex gdbserver
9658 @cindex remote connection without stubs
9659 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9660 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9661 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9662
9663 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9664 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9665 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9666 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9667 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9668 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9669 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9670 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9671 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9672 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9673 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9674 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9675 choice for debugging.
9676
9677 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9678 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9679 protocol.
9680
9681 @table @emph
9682 @item On the target machine,
9683 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9684 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9685 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9686 system does all the symbol handling.
9687
9688 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9689 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9690 syntax is:
9691
9692 @smallexample
9693 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9694 @end smallexample
9695
9696 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9697 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9698 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9699 @file{/dev/com1}:
9700
9701 @smallexample
9702 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9703 @end smallexample
9704
9705 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9706 with it.
9707
9708 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9709
9710 @smallexample
9711 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9712 @end smallexample
9713
9714 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9715 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9716 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9717 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9718 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9719 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9720 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9721 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9722 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9723 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9724 @code{target remote} command.
9725
9726 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9727 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9728 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9729 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9730 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9731 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
9732 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9733 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9734 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9735 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9736
9737 @smallexample
9738 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9739 @end smallexample
9740
9741 @noindent
9742 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9743
9744 @smallexample
9745 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9746 @end smallexample
9747
9748 @noindent
9749 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9750 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9751 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9752 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9753 @samp{Connection refused}.
9754 @end table
9755
9756 @node NetWare
9757 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9758
9759 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
9760 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9761 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9762 @code{target remote}.
9763
9764 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9765 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9766
9767 @table @emph
9768 @item On the target machine,
9769 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9770 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9771 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9772 host system does all the symbol handling.
9773
9774 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9775 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9776 program. The syntax is:
9777
9778 @smallexample
9779 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9780 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9781 @end smallexample
9782
9783 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9784 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
9785 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
9786
9787 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9788 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
9789 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
9790
9791 @smallexample
9792 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9793 @end smallexample
9794
9795 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9796 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9797 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9798 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9799 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9800 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
9801 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9802 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9803 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9804
9805 @smallexample
9806 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9807 @end smallexample
9808
9809 @noindent
9810 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9811 @end table
9812
9813 @node KOD
9814 @section Kernel Object Display
9815
9816 @cindex kernel object display
9817 @cindex kernel object
9818 @cindex KOD
9819
9820 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9821 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9822 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9823 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9824 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9825
9826 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9827 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9828
9829 @example
9830 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9831 @end example
9832
9833 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9834 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9835 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9836 after the operating system:
9837
9838 @example
9839 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9840 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9841 Object Description
9842 any Any and all objects
9843 @end example
9844
9845 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9846 by the kernel.
9847
9848 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9849 is supported other than to try it.
9850
9851
9852 @node Configurations
9853 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9854
9855 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9856 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9857 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9858
9859 There are three major categories of configurations: native
9860 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9861 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9862 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9863 are quite different from each other.
9864
9865 @menu
9866 * Native::
9867 * Embedded OS::
9868 * Embedded Processors::
9869 * Architectures::
9870 @end menu
9871
9872 @node Native
9873 @section Native
9874
9875 This section describes details specific to particular native
9876 configurations.
9877
9878 @menu
9879 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
9880 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9881 @end menu
9882
9883 @node HP-UX
9884 @subsection HP-UX
9885
9886 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9887 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9888 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9889
9890 @node SVR4 Process Information
9891 @subsection SVR4 process information
9892
9893 @kindex /proc
9894 @cindex process image
9895
9896 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9897 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9898 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9899 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9900 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9901 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9902 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9903 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9904
9905 @table @code
9906 @kindex info proc
9907 @item info proc
9908 Summarize available information about the process.
9909
9910 @kindex info proc mappings
9911 @item info proc mappings
9912 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9913 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9914
9915 @kindex info proc times
9916 @item info proc times
9917 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9918 its children.
9919
9920 @kindex info proc id
9921 @item info proc id
9922 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9923 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9924
9925 @kindex info proc status
9926 @item info proc status
9927 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9928 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9929 received.
9930
9931 @item info proc all
9932 Show all the above information about the process.
9933 @end table
9934
9935 @node Embedded OS
9936 @section Embedded Operating Systems
9937
9938 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9939 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9940 architectures.
9941
9942 @menu
9943 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9944 @end menu
9945
9946 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9947 various real-time operating systems.
9948
9949 @node VxWorks
9950 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9951
9952 @cindex VxWorks
9953
9954 @table @code
9955
9956 @kindex target vxworks
9957 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9958 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9959 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9960
9961 @end table
9962
9963 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9964 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9965
9966 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9967 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9968 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9969 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
9970 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
9971 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
9972 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
9973
9974 @table @code
9975 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9976 @kindex vxworks-timeout
9977 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9978 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9979 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9980 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9981 of a thin network line.
9982 @end table
9983
9984 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9985 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9986 procedures.
9987
9988 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9989 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9990 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9991 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9992 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9993 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9994 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9995 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9996 manual.
9997 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9998
9999 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10000 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10001 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10002 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
10003
10004 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10005
10006 @example
10007 (vxgdb)
10008 @end example
10009
10010 @menu
10011 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10012 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10013 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10014 @end menu
10015
10016 @node VxWorks Connection
10017 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10018
10019 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10020 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10021
10022 @example
10023 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10024 @end example
10025
10026 @need 750
10027 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10028
10029 @smallexample
10030 Attaching remote machine across net...
10031 Connected to tt.
10032 @end smallexample
10033
10034 @need 1000
10035 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10036 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10037 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10038 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10039 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10040
10041 @example
10042 prog.o: No such file or directory.
10043 @end example
10044
10045 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10046 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10047 command again.
10048
10049 @node VxWorks Download
10050 @subsubsection VxWorks download
10051
10052 @cindex download to VxWorks
10053 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10054 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10055 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10056 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10057 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10058 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10059 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10060 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10061 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10062 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10063 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10064 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10065 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10066 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10067 program, type this on VxWorks:
10068
10069 @example
10070 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10071 @end example
10072
10073 @noindent
10074 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10075
10076 @example
10077 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10078 (vxgdb) load prog.o
10079 @end example
10080
10081 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10082
10083 @smallexample
10084 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10085 @end smallexample
10086
10087 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10088 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10089 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10090 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10091 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10092 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10093 table.)
10094
10095 @node VxWorks Attach
10096 @subsubsection Running tasks
10097
10098 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
10099 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10100 follows:
10101
10102 @example
10103 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10104 @end example
10105
10106 @noindent
10107 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10108 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10109 the time of attachment.
10110
10111 @node Embedded Processors
10112 @section Embedded Processors
10113
10114 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10115 configurations.
10116
10117 @menu
10118 * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10119 * ARM:: ARM
10120 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10121 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10122 * i960:: Intel i960
10123 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10124 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
10125 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
10126 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10127 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
10128 * PowerPC: PowerPC
10129 * SH:: Hitachi SH
10130 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10131 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10132 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10133 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10134 @end menu
10135
10136 @node A29K Embedded
10137 @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10138
10139 @menu
10140 * A29K UDI::
10141 * A29K EB29K::
10142 * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10143 * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10144 * Remote Log:: Remote log
10145 @end menu
10146
10147 @table @code
10148
10149 @kindex target adapt
10150 @item target adapt @var{dev}
10151 Adapt monitor for A29K.
10152
10153 @kindex target amd-eb
10154 @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10155 @cindex AMD EB29K
10156 Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10157 @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10158 @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10159 name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10160 @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10161
10162 @end table
10163
10164 @node A29K UDI
10165 @subsubsection A29K UDI
10166
10167 @cindex UDI
10168 @cindex AMD29K via UDI
10169
10170 @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10171 protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10172 configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10173 program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10174 use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10175 @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10176
10177 @table @code
10178 @item target udi @var{keyword}
10179 @kindex udi
10180 Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10181 @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10182 This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10183 connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10184 working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10185 to its pathname.
10186 @end table
10187
10188 @node A29K EB29K
10189 @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10190
10191 @cindex EB29K board
10192 @cindex running 29K programs
10193
10194 AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10195 with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10196 term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10197 @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10198 must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10199 board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10200 assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10201 @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10202
10203 @node Comms (EB29K)
10204 @subsubsection Communications setup
10205
10206 The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10207 in DOS on the PC:
10208
10209 @example
10210 C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10211 @end example
10212
10213 @noindent
10214 This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10215 bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10216 you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10217 end of the connection as well.
10218 @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10219 @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10220 @c
10221 @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10222 @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10223 @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10224 @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10225 @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
10226
10227 To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10228 the following at the DOS console:
10229
10230 @example
10231 C:\> CTTY com1
10232 @end example
10233
10234 @noindent
10235 (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10236 the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
10237 had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
10238
10239 From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10240 @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10241
10242 @example
10243 cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10244 @end example
10245
10246 @noindent
10247 The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10248 serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10249 may look something like the following:
10250
10251 @example
10252 tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10253 @end example
10254
10255 @noindent
10256 Your system may require a different name where we show
10257 @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10258 parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10259 @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10260 system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10261 @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10262 @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10263 @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10264 @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10265 @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10266 @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10267 @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10268 @c
10269 @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10270 @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10271 @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
10272
10273 @kindex EBMON
10274 Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10275 directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10276 start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10277 with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10278 @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10279 @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10280
10281 @example
10282 C:\> G:
10283
10284 G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10285
10286 G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10287 Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10288 Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10289 Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10290
10291 Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10292
10293 PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10294 I/O Base = 0x208
10295 Memory Base = 0xd0000
10296
10297 Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10298 Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10299 Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10300
10301 PageSize = 0x400
10302 Register Stack Size = 0x800
10303 Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10304
10305 CPU PRL = 0x3
10306 Am29027 Available = No
10307 Byte Write Available = Yes
10308
10309 # ~.
10310 @end example
10311
10312 Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10313 typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10314 running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10315
10316 For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10317 way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
10318 system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
10319 PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10320 something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10321 other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10322 from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10323 serial line.
10324
10325 @node gdb-EB29K
10326 @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10327
10328 Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10329 program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10330 name of your 29K program:
10331
10332 @example
10333 cd /usr/joe/work29k
10334 @value{GDBP} myfoo
10335 @end example
10336
10337 @need 500
10338 Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10339
10340 @example
10341 target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10342 @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10343 @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10344 @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10345 @end example
10346
10347 @noindent
10348 In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10349 @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10350 @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10351 In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10352 a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10353 the name on the Unix side.
10354
10355 At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10356 to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10357 @code{run}.
10358
10359 To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10360 command.
10361
10362 To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10363 once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10364 @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10365 @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
10366 Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
10367 and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10368
10369 @node Remote Log
10370 @subsubsection Remote log
10371 @cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
10372 @cindex log file for EB29K
10373
10374 The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10375 current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10376 @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10377 of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10378 another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10379 unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10380
10381 @node ARM
10382 @subsection ARM
10383
10384 @table @code
10385
10386 @kindex target rdi
10387 @item target rdi @var{dev}
10388 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10389 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10390 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10391
10392 @kindex target rdp
10393 @item target rdp @var{dev}
10394 ARM Demon monitor.
10395
10396 @end table
10397
10398 @node H8/300
10399 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
10400
10401 @table @code
10402
10403 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
10404 @item target hms @var{dev}
10405 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10406 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10407 line and the communications speed used.
10408
10409 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
10410 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
10411 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10412
10413 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10414 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
10415 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
10416 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
10417 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10418
10419 @end table
10420
10421 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10422 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10423 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
10424 @cindex Hitachi SH download
10425 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10426 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10427 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10428 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10429
10430 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10431 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10432
10433 @enumerate
10434 @item
10435 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10436 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10437 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
10438 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
10439 H8/300, or H8/500.)
10440
10441 @item
10442 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10443 serial device available on your host is the default).
10444
10445 @item
10446 what speed to use over the serial device.
10447 @end enumerate
10448
10449 @menu
10450 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10451 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10452 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10453 @end menu
10454
10455 @node Hitachi Boards
10456 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10457
10458 @c only for Unix hosts
10459 @kindex device
10460 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10461 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10462 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10463 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10464 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10465
10466 @kindex speed
10467 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10468 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
10469 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
10470 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
10471 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10472 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
10473
10474 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10475 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10476 use a DOS host,
10477 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10478 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10479 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10480 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10481
10482 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10483 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10484 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10485 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10486
10487 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10488 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10489 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10490 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
10491 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
10492 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10493 @code{COM2}.
10494
10495 @example
10496 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10497 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10498
10499 Resident portion of MODE loaded
10500
10501 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10502
10503 @end example
10504
10505 @quotation
10506 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10507 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10508 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10509 your development board.
10510 @end quotation
10511
10512 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
10513 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10514 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10515 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
10516 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10517 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10518 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10519 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10520 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10521 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10522 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10523 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10524 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10525
10526 @smallexample
10527 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
10528 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
10529 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10530 the conditions.
10531 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
10532 for details.
10533 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10534 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
10535 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
10536 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
10537 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10538 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10539 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10540 @end smallexample
10541
10542 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10543 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10544 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10545 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10546 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10547 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10548
10549 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10550 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10551 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10552
10553 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10554 @itemize @bullet
10555 @item
10556 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10557 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10558
10559 @item
10560 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10561 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10562 to detect program completion.
10563 @end itemize
10564
10565 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10566 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10567
10568 @node Hitachi ICE
10569 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10570
10571 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
10572 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10573 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10574 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10575
10576 @table @code
10577 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10578 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10579 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10580 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10581 (for example, @samp{9600}).
10582
10583 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10584 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10585 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10586 @end table
10587
10588 @node Hitachi Special
10589 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10590
10591 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10592
10593 @table @code
10594
10595 @kindex set machine
10596 @kindex show machine
10597 @item set machine h8300
10598 @itemx set machine h8300h
10599 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10600 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10601 to check which variant is currently in effect.
10602
10603 @end table
10604
10605 @node H8/500
10606 @subsection H8/500
10607
10608 @table @code
10609
10610 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
10611 @cindex memory models, H8/500
10612 @item set memory @var{mod}
10613 @itemx show memory
10614 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10615 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10616 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10617 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10618
10619 @end table
10620
10621 @node i960
10622 @subsection Intel i960
10623
10624 @table @code
10625
10626 @kindex target mon960
10627 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
10628 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10629
10630 @kindex target nindy
10631 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
10632 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10633 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10634 @file{/dev/ttya}.
10635
10636 @end table
10637
10638 @cindex Nindy
10639 @cindex i960
10640 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10641 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10642 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10643
10644 @itemize @bullet
10645 @item
10646 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10647 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10648
10649 @item
10650 By responding to a prompt on startup;
10651
10652 @item
10653 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10654 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10655
10656 @end itemize
10657
10658 @cindex download to Nindy-960
10659 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10660 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10661 @value{GDBN}.
10662
10663 @menu
10664 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10665 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10666 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10667 @end menu
10668
10669 @node Nindy Startup
10670 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10671
10672 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10673 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10674 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10675
10676 @example
10677 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10678 @end example
10679
10680 @noindent
10681 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10682 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10683 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10684 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10685 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10686
10687 @node Nindy Options
10688 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
10689
10690 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10691 Nindy-960 board attached:
10692
10693 @table @code
10694 @item -r @var{port}
10695 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10696 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10697 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10698 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10699 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10700 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10701
10702 @item -O
10703 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10704 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10705 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10706 target architecture.
10707
10708 @quotation
10709 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10710 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10711 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10712 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10713 this process with an interrupt.
10714 @end quotation
10715
10716 @item -brk
10717 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10718 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10719
10720 @quotation
10721 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10722 requires; it only works with a few boards.
10723 @end quotation
10724 @end table
10725
10726 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10727 port.
10728
10729 @c @group
10730 @node Nindy Reset
10731 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
10732
10733 @table @code
10734 @item reset
10735 @kindex reset
10736 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10737 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10738 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10739 a break is detected.
10740 @end table
10741 @c @end group
10742
10743 @node M32R/D
10744 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10745
10746 @table @code
10747
10748 @kindex target m32r
10749 @item target m32r @var{dev}
10750 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10751
10752 @end table
10753
10754 @node M68K
10755 @subsection M68k
10756
10757 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10758 target command for the following ROM monitors.
10759
10760 @table @code
10761
10762 @kindex target abug
10763 @item target abug @var{dev}
10764 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10765
10766 @kindex target cpu32bug
10767 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10768 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10769
10770 @kindex target dbug
10771 @item target dbug @var{dev}
10772 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10773
10774 @kindex target est
10775 @item target est @var{dev}
10776 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10777
10778 @kindex target rom68k
10779 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
10780 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10781
10782 @end table
10783
10784 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10785 instead have only a single special target command:
10786
10787 @table @code
10788
10789 @kindex target es1800
10790 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
10791 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10792
10793 @end table
10794
10795 [context?]
10796
10797 @table @code
10798
10799 @kindex target rombug
10800 @item target rombug @var{dev}
10801 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10802
10803 @end table
10804
10805 @node M88K
10806 @subsection M88K
10807
10808 @table @code
10809
10810 @kindex target bug
10811 @item target bug @var{dev}
10812 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10813
10814 @end table
10815
10816 @node MIPS Embedded
10817 @subsection MIPS Embedded
10818
10819 @cindex MIPS boards
10820 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10821 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10822 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10823
10824 @need 1000
10825 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10826
10827 @table @code
10828 @item target mips @var{port}
10829 @kindex target mips @var{port}
10830 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10831 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10832 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10833 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10834 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10835 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10836
10837 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10838 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10839 debugger:
10840
10841 @example
10842 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
10843 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10844 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10845 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10846 (@value{GDBP}) run
10847 @end example
10848
10849 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10850 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10851 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10852 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10853 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10854
10855 @item target pmon @var{port}
10856 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
10857 PMON ROM monitor.
10858
10859 @item target ddb @var{port}
10860 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
10861 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10862
10863 @item target lsi @var{port}
10864 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
10865 LSI variant of PMON.
10866
10867 @kindex target r3900
10868 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
10869 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10870
10871 @kindex target array
10872 @item target array @var{dev}
10873 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10874
10875 @end table
10876
10877
10878 @noindent
10879 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10880
10881 @table @code
10882 @item set processor @var{args}
10883 @itemx show processor
10884 @kindex set processor @var{args}
10885 @kindex show processor
10886 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10887 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10888 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10889 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10890 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10891 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10892 @value{GDBN} is using.
10893
10894 @item set mipsfpu double
10895 @itemx set mipsfpu single
10896 @itemx set mipsfpu none
10897 @itemx show mipsfpu
10898 @kindex set mipsfpu
10899 @kindex show mipsfpu
10900 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
10901 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10902 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10903 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10904 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
10905 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10906 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10907 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10908 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10909 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10910 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10911 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10912 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10913
10914 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10915 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10916 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10917
10918 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10919 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
10920
10921 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
10922 @itemx show remotedebug
10923 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10924 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10925 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10926 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10927 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10928 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10929 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10930 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10931 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10932 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10933 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10934
10935 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
10936 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10937 @itemx show timeout
10938 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
10939 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10940 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10941 @kindex set timeout
10942 @kindex show timeout
10943 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
10944 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
10945 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10946 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10947 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10948 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10949 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10950 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10951 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10952 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10953
10954 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10955 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10956 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10957 to run before stopping.
10958 @end table
10959
10960 @node PowerPC
10961 @subsection PowerPC
10962
10963 @table @code
10964
10965 @kindex target dink32
10966 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
10967 DINK32 ROM monitor.
10968
10969 @kindex target ppcbug
10970 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10971 @kindex target ppcbug1
10972 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10973 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10974
10975 @kindex target sds
10976 @item target sds @var{dev}
10977 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10978
10979 @end table
10980
10981 @node PA
10982 @subsection HP PA Embedded
10983
10984 @table @code
10985
10986 @kindex target op50n
10987 @item target op50n @var{dev}
10988 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10989
10990 @kindex target w89k
10991 @item target w89k @var{dev}
10992 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10993
10994 @end table
10995
10996 @node SH
10997 @subsection Hitachi SH
10998
10999 @table @code
11000
11001 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11002 @item target hms @var{dev}
11003 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11004 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11005 the communications speed used.
11006
11007 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11008 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11009 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11010
11011 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11012 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11013 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11014 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
11015 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11016
11017 @end table
11018
11019 @node Sparclet
11020 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11021
11022 @cindex Sparclet
11023
11024 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11025 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11026 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11027 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11028 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11029
11030 @table @code
11031 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
11032 @kindex remotetimeout
11033 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11034 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11035 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11036 @end table
11037
11038 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11039 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11040 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11041 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11042 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
11043
11044 @example
11045 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11046 @end example
11047
11048 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11049
11050 @example
11051 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11052 @end example
11053
11054 @cindex running, on Sparclet
11055 Once you have set
11056 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11057 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11058 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11059
11060 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11061
11062 @example
11063 (gdbslet)
11064 @end example
11065
11066 @menu
11067 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11068 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11069 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11070 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
11071 @end menu
11072
11073 @node Sparclet File
11074 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
11075
11076 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11077
11078 @example
11079 (gdbslet) file prog
11080 @end example
11081
11082 @need 1000
11083 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11084 @value{GDBN} locates
11085 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11086 path.
11087 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11088 files will be searched as well.
11089 @value{GDBN} locates
11090 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11091 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11092 If it fails
11093 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11094
11095 @example
11096 prog: No such file or directory.
11097 @end example
11098
11099 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11100 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11101 @code{target} command again.
11102
11103 @node Sparclet Connection
11104 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11105
11106 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11107 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11108
11109 @example
11110 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11111 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11112 main () at ../prog.c:3
11113 @end example
11114
11115 @need 750
11116 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11117
11118 @example
11119 Connected to ttya.
11120 @end example
11121
11122 @node Sparclet Download
11123 @subsubsection Sparclet download
11124
11125 @cindex download to Sparclet
11126 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11127 you can use the @value{GDBN}
11128 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11129 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11130 command.
11131 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11132 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
11133 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11134 of each of the file's sections.
11135 For instance, if the program
11136 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11137 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11138
11139 @example
11140 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11141 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11142 @end example
11143
11144 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11145 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11146 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11147
11148 @node Sparclet Execution
11149 @subsubsection Running and debugging
11150
11151 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11152 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11153 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
11154 manual for the list of commands.
11155
11156 @example
11157 (gdbslet) b main
11158 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11159 (gdbslet) run
11160 Starting program: prog
11161 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
11162 3 char *symarg = 0;
11163 (gdbslet) step
11164 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
11165 (gdbslet)
11166 @end example
11167
11168 @node Sparclite
11169 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11170
11171 @table @code
11172
11173 @kindex target sparclite
11174 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
11175 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11176 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11177 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11178 remote protocol.
11179
11180 @end table
11181
11182 @node ST2000
11183 @subsection Tandem ST2000
11184
11185 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
11186 STDBUG protocol.
11187
11188 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11189 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11190
11191 @example
11192 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11193 @end example
11194
11195 @noindent
11196 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11197 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11198 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11199 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11200 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11201
11202 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11203 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11204 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11205 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11206 available on your host computer.
11207 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11208 @c basically hearsay.
11209
11210 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11211 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11212 environment:
11213
11214 @table @code
11215 @item st2000 @var{command}
11216 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11217 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11218 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11219 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11220 manual for available commands.
11221
11222 @item connect
11223 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11224 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11225 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11226 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11227 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11228 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11229 @end table
11230
11231 @node Z8000
11232 @subsection Zilog Z8000
11233
11234 @cindex Z8000
11235 @cindex simulator, Z8000
11236 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11237
11238 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11239 a Z8000 simulator.
11240
11241 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11242 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11243 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11244 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11245
11246 @table @code
11247 @item target sim @var{args}
11248 @kindex sim
11249 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
11250 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11251 options, specify them via @var{args}.
11252 @end table
11253
11254 @noindent
11255 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11256 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11257 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11258 to run your program, and so on.
11259
11260 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11261 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11262 additional items of information as specially named registers:
11263
11264 @table @code
11265
11266 @item cycles
11267 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11268
11269 @item insts
11270 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11271
11272 @item time
11273 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11274
11275 @end table
11276
11277 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11278 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11279 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11280 simulated clock ticks.
11281
11282 @node Architectures
11283 @section Architectures
11284
11285 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
11286 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
11287
11288 @menu
11289 * A29K::
11290 * Alpha::
11291 * MIPS::
11292 @end menu
11293
11294 @node A29K
11295 @subsection A29K
11296
11297 @table @code
11298
11299 @kindex set rstack_high_address
11300 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
11301 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
11302 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11303 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
11304 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
11305 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11306 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11307 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11308 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11309 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11310 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11311 hexadecimal.
11312
11313 @kindex show rstack_high_address
11314 @item show rstack_high_address
11315 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11316 processors.
11317
11318 @end table
11319
11320 @node Alpha
11321 @subsection Alpha
11322
11323 See the following section.
11324
11325 @node MIPS
11326 @subsection MIPS
11327
11328 @cindex stack on Alpha
11329 @cindex stack on MIPS
11330 @cindex Alpha stack
11331 @cindex MIPS stack
11332 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11333 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11334 find the beginning of a function.
11335
11336 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11337 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11338 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11339 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11340 commands:
11341
11342 @table @code
11343 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
11344 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11345 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11346 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11347 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11348 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11349 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11350
11351 @item show heuristic-fence-post
11352 Display the current limit.
11353 @end table
11354
11355 @noindent
11356 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11357 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11358
11359
11360 @node Controlling GDB
11361 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11362
11363 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11364 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
11365 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
11366 described here.
11367
11368 @menu
11369 * Prompt:: Prompt
11370 * Editing:: Command editing
11371 * History:: Command history
11372 * Screen Size:: Screen size
11373 * Numbers:: Numbers
11374 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11375 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
11376 @end menu
11377
11378 @node Prompt
11379 @section Prompt
11380
11381 @cindex prompt
11382
11383 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11384 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11385 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11386 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11387 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11388 which one you are talking to.
11389
11390 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
11391 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11392 or a prompt that does not.
11393
11394 @table @code
11395 @kindex set prompt
11396 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11397 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11398
11399 @kindex show prompt
11400 @item show prompt
11401 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11402 @end table
11403
11404 @node Editing
11405 @section Command editing
11406 @cindex readline
11407 @cindex command line editing
11408
11409 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11410 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11411 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11412 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11413 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11414 debugging sessions.
11415
11416 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11417 command @code{set}.
11418
11419 @table @code
11420 @kindex set editing
11421 @cindex editing
11422 @item set editing
11423 @itemx set editing on
11424 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11425
11426 @item set editing off
11427 Disable command line editing.
11428
11429 @kindex show editing
11430 @item show editing
11431 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11432 @end table
11433
11434 @node History
11435 @section Command history
11436
11437 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11438 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11439 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11440 history facility.
11441
11442 @table @code
11443 @cindex history substitution
11444 @cindex history file
11445 @kindex set history filename
11446 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
11447 @item set history filename @var{fname}
11448 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11449 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11450 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11451 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11452 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11453 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
11454 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11455 is not set.
11456
11457 @cindex history save
11458 @kindex set history save
11459 @item set history save
11460 @itemx set history save on
11461 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11462 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11463
11464 @item set history save off
11465 Stop recording command history in a file.
11466
11467 @cindex history size
11468 @kindex set history size
11469 @item set history size @var{size}
11470 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11471 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11472 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11473 @end table
11474
11475 @cindex history expansion
11476 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11477 @ifset have-readline-appendices
11478 @xref{Event Designators}.
11479 @end ifset
11480
11481 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11482 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11483 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11484 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11485 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11486 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11487 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11488
11489 The commands to control history expansion are:
11490
11491 @table @code
11492 @kindex set history expansion
11493 @item set history expansion on
11494 @itemx set history expansion
11495 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11496
11497 @item set history expansion off
11498 Disable history expansion.
11499
11500 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11501 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11502 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11503 @ifset have-readline-appendices
11504 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
11505 @end ifset
11506
11507 @c @group
11508 @kindex show history
11509 @item show history
11510 @itemx show history filename
11511 @itemx show history save
11512 @itemx show history size
11513 @itemx show history expansion
11514 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11515 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11516 @c @end group
11517 @end table
11518
11519 @table @code
11520 @kindex shows
11521 @item show commands
11522 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11523
11524 @item show commands @var{n}
11525 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11526
11527 @item show commands +
11528 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11529 @end table
11530
11531 @node Screen Size
11532 @section Screen size
11533 @cindex size of screen
11534 @cindex pauses in output
11535
11536 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11537 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11538 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11539 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11540 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11541 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11542 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11543 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11544
11545 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11546 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
11547 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
11548 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
11549 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11550 width} commands:
11551
11552 @table @code
11553 @kindex set height
11554 @kindex set width
11555 @kindex show width
11556 @kindex show height
11557 @item set height @var{lpp}
11558 @itemx show height
11559 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
11560 @itemx show width
11561 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11562 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11563 commands display the current settings.
11564
11565 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11566 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11567 file or to an editor buffer.
11568
11569 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11570 from wrapping its output.
11571 @end table
11572
11573 @node Numbers
11574 @section Numbers
11575 @cindex number representation
11576 @cindex entering numbers
11577
11578 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11579 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11580 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11581 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11582 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11583 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11584 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11585 radix} command.
11586
11587 @table @code
11588 @kindex set input-radix
11589 @item set input-radix @var{base}
11590 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11591 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11592 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11593 example, any of
11594
11595 @smallexample
11596 set radix 012
11597 set radix 10.
11598 set radix 0xa
11599 @end smallexample
11600
11601 @noindent
11602 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11603 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11604
11605 @kindex set output-radix
11606 @item set output-radix @var{base}
11607 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11608 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11609 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11610
11611 @kindex show input-radix
11612 @item show input-radix
11613 Display the current default base for numeric input.
11614
11615 @kindex show output-radix
11616 @item show output-radix
11617 Display the current default base for numeric display.
11618 @end table
11619
11620 @node Messages/Warnings
11621 @section Optional warnings and messages
11622
11623 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11624 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11625 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11626 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
11627
11628 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11629 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11630 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11631
11632 @table @code
11633 @kindex set verbose
11634 @item set verbose on
11635 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11636
11637 @item set verbose off
11638 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11639
11640 @kindex show verbose
11641 @item show verbose
11642 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11643 @end table
11644
11645 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11646 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11647 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11648 symbol files}).
11649
11650 @table @code
11651
11652 @kindex set complaints
11653 @item set complaints @var{limit}
11654 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11655 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11656 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11657 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
11658
11659 @kindex show complaints
11660 @item show complaints
11661 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
11662
11663 @end table
11664
11665 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11666 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11667 you try to run a program which is already running:
11668
11669 @example
11670 (@value{GDBP}) run
11671 The program being debugged has been started already.
11672 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11673 @end example
11674
11675 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11676 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11677
11678 @table @code
11679
11680 @kindex set confirm
11681 @cindex flinching
11682 @cindex confirmation
11683 @cindex stupid questions
11684 @item set confirm off
11685 Disables confirmation requests.
11686
11687 @item set confirm on
11688 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11689
11690 @kindex show confirm
11691 @item show confirm
11692 Displays state of confirmation requests.
11693
11694 @end table
11695
11696 @node Debugging Output
11697 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
11698 @table @code
11699 @kindex set debug arch
11700 @item set debug arch
11701 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11702 @kindex show debug arch
11703 @item show debug arch
11704 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11705 @kindex set debug event
11706 @item set debug event
11707 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11708 default is off.
11709 @kindex show debug event
11710 @item show debug event
11711 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11712 info.
11713 @kindex set debug expression
11714 @item set debug expression
11715 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11716 default is off.
11717 @kindex show debug expression
11718 @item show debug expression
11719 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11720 debugging info.
11721 @kindex set debug overload
11722 @item set debug overload
11723 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11724 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11725 is off.
11726 @kindex show debug overload
11727 @item show debug overload
11728 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11729 debugging info.
11730 @kindex set debug remote
11731 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11732 @cindex serial connections, debugging
11733 @item set debug remote
11734 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11735 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
11736 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11737 @kindex show debug remote
11738 @item show debug remote
11739 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11740 @kindex set debug serial
11741 @item set debug serial
11742 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11743 default is off.
11744 @kindex show debug serial
11745 @item show debug serial
11746 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11747 info.
11748 @kindex set debug target
11749 @item set debug target
11750 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11751 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11752 default is off.
11753 @kindex show debug target
11754 @item show debug target
11755 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11756 info.
11757 @kindex set debug varobj
11758 @item set debug varobj
11759 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11760 info. The default is off.
11761 @kindex show debug varobj
11762 @item show debug varobj
11763 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11764 debugging info.
11765 @end table
11766
11767 @node Sequences
11768 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11769
11770 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
11771 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11772 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11773 files.
11774
11775 @menu
11776 * Define:: User-defined commands
11777 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11778 * Command Files:: Command files
11779 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
11780 @end menu
11781
11782 @node Define
11783 @section User-defined commands
11784
11785 @cindex user-defined command
11786 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11787 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11788 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11789 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11790 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
11791
11792 @smallexample
11793 define adder
11794 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11795 @end smallexample
11796
11797 @noindent
11798 To execute the command use:
11799
11800 @smallexample
11801 adder 1 2 3
11802 @end smallexample
11803
11804 @noindent
11805 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
11806 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11807 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11808 functions calls.
11809
11810 @table @code
11811
11812 @kindex define
11813 @item define @var{commandname}
11814 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11815 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11816
11817 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11818 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11819 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11820
11821 @kindex if
11822 @kindex else
11823 @item if
11824 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11825 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11826 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11827 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11828 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11829 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11830
11831 @kindex while
11832 @item while
11833 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11834 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11835 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11836 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11837 evaluates to true.
11838
11839 @kindex document
11840 @item document @var{commandname}
11841 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11842 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11843 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11844 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11845 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11846 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11847
11848 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11849 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11850 does not change the documentation.
11851
11852 @kindex help user-defined
11853 @item help user-defined
11854 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11855 (if any) for each.
11856
11857 @kindex show user
11858 @item show user
11859 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
11860 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11861 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
11862 definitions for all user-defined commands.
11863
11864 @end table
11865
11866 When user-defined commands are executed, the
11867 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11868 stops execution of the user-defined command.
11869
11870 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11871 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11872 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11873 messages when used in a user-defined command.
11874
11875 @node Hooks
11876 @section User-defined command hooks
11877 @cindex command hooks
11878 @cindex hooks, for commands
11879 @cindex hooks, pre-command
11880
11881 @kindex hook
11882 @kindex hook-
11883 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11884 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11885 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11886 before that command.
11887
11888 @cindex hooks, post-command
11889 @kindex hookpost
11890 @kindex hookpost-
11891 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
11892 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
11893 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
11894 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
11895 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
11896
11897 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
11898 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
11899
11900 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
11901 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
11902
11903 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
11904 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11905 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11906 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11907 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11908
11909 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11910 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11911 you could define:
11912
11913 @example
11914 define hook-stop
11915 handle SIGALRM nopass
11916 end
11917
11918 define hook-run
11919 handle SIGALRM pass
11920 end
11921
11922 define hook-continue
11923 handle SIGLARM pass
11924 end
11925 @end example
11926
11927 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
11928 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
11929 you could define:
11930
11931 @example
11932 define hook-echo
11933 echo <<<---
11934 end
11935
11936 define hookpost-echo
11937 echo --->>>\n
11938 end
11939
11940 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
11941 <<<---Hello World--->>>
11942 (@value{GDBP})
11943
11944 @end example
11945
11946 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11947 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11948 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11949 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11950 @c or not?
11951 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11952 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11953 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11954
11955 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11956 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11957
11958 @node Command Files
11959 @section Command files
11960
11961 @cindex command files
11962 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11963 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11964 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11965 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11966
11967 @cindex init file
11968 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
11969 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
11970 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11971 @dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
11972 @file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
11973 following:
11974
11975 @enumerate
11976 @item
11977 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
11978 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
11979 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
11980
11981 @item
11982 Processes command line options and operands.
11983
11984 @item
11985 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
11986
11987 @item
11988 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
11989 @end enumerate
11990
11991 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
11992 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
11993 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
11994 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
11995
11996 @cindex init file name
11997 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11998 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11999 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12000 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12001 environments with special init file names:
12002
12003 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12004 @itemize @bullet
12005 @item
12006 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12007
12008 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12009 @item
12010 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12011
12012 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12013 @item
12014 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12015 @end itemize
12016
12017 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12018 @code{source} command:
12019
12020 @table @code
12021 @kindex source
12022 @item source @var{filename}
12023 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12024 @end table
12025
12026 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12027 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12028 of the command file.
12029
12030 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12031 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12032 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12033 when called from command files.
12034
12035 @node Output
12036 @section Commands for controlled output
12037
12038 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12039 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12040 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12041 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12042 want.
12043
12044 @table @code
12045 @kindex echo
12046 @item echo @var{text}
12047 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12048 @c because it is not in ANSI.
12049 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12050 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12051 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12052 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12053 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12054 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12055 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12056 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12057 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12058
12059 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12060 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12061
12062 @example
12063 echo This is some text\n\
12064 which is continued\n\
12065 onto several lines.\n
12066 @end example
12067
12068 produces the same output as
12069
12070 @example
12071 echo This is some text\n
12072 echo which is continued\n
12073 echo onto several lines.\n
12074 @end example
12075
12076 @kindex output
12077 @item output @var{expression}
12078 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12079 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
12080 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12081 on expressions.
12082
12083 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12084 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12085 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12086 formats}, for more information.
12087
12088 @kindex printf
12089 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12090 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12091 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12092 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12093 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12094 subroutine
12095 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12096 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12097 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12098 @c supported.
12099
12100 @example
12101 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12102 @end example
12103
12104 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12105
12106 @smallexample
12107 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12108 @end smallexample
12109
12110 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12111 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12112 letter.
12113 @end table
12114
12115 @node Emacs
12116 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12117
12118 @cindex Emacs
12119 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12120 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12121 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12122 @value{GDBN}.
12123
12124 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12125 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12126 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12127 created Emacs buffer.
12128 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
12129
12130 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12131 things:
12132
12133 @itemize @bullet
12134 @item
12135 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12136 @end itemize
12137
12138 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12139 and output done by the program you are debugging.
12140
12141 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12142 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12143 in this way.
12144
12145 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12146 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12147 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12148 stop.
12149
12150 @itemize @bullet
12151 @item
12152 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12153 @end itemize
12154
12155 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12156 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12157 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12158 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12159 and the source.
12160
12161 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12162 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12163
12164 @quotation
12165 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12166 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12167 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12168 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12169 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12170 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12171 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12172 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12173 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12174 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12175
12176 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12177 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12178 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12179 @end quotation
12180
12181 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12182 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12183 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12184 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12185
12186 @example
12187 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12188 @end example
12189
12190 @noindent
12191 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
12192 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12193 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12194
12195 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12196 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12197
12198 @table @kbd
12199 @item C-h m
12200 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12201
12202 @item M-s
12203 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12204 update the display window to show the current file and location.
12205
12206 @item M-n
12207 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12208 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
12209 to show the current file and location.
12210
12211 @item M-i
12212 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12213 display window accordingly.
12214
12215 @item M-x gdb-nexti
12216 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12217 display window accordingly.
12218
12219 @item C-c C-f
12220 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12221 @code{finish} command.
12222
12223 @item M-c
12224 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12225 command.
12226
12227 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12228
12229 @item M-u
12230 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12231 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12232 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12233
12234 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12235
12236 @item M-d
12237 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12238 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12239
12240 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12241
12242 @item C-x &
12243 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12244 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12245 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12246 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12247 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12248
12249 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12250 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12251 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12252 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12253 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12254 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12255 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12256 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12257 @end table
12258
12259 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12260 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12261
12262 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12263 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12264 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12265 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12266 frame.
12267
12268 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12269 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12270 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12271 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12272 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12273 to correspond properly with the code.
12274
12275 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12276 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12277 @ignore
12278 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12279 @kindex Epoch
12280 @kindex inspect
12281
12282 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
12283 called the @code{epoch}
12284 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12285 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12286 each value is printed in its own window.
12287 @end ignore
12288
12289 @include annotate.texi
12290 @include gdbmi.texinfo
12291
12292 @node GDB Bugs
12293 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12294 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12295 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12296
12297 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12298
12299 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12300 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12301 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12302 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12303
12304 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12305 information that enables us to fix the bug.
12306
12307 @menu
12308 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12309 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12310 @end menu
12311
12312 @node Bug Criteria
12313 @section Have you found a bug?
12314 @cindex bug criteria
12315
12316 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12317
12318 @itemize @bullet
12319 @cindex fatal signal
12320 @cindex debugger crash
12321 @cindex crash of debugger
12322 @item
12323 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12324 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12325
12326 @cindex error on valid input
12327 @item
12328 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12329 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12330 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12331
12332 @cindex invalid input
12333 @item
12334 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12335 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12336 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12337 for traditional practice''.
12338
12339 @item
12340 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12341 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12342 @end itemize
12343
12344 @node Bug Reporting
12345 @section How to report bugs
12346 @cindex bug reports
12347 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12348
12349 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12350 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12351 contact that organization first.
12352
12353 You can find contact information for many support companies and
12354 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12355 distribution.
12356 @c should add a web page ref...
12357
12358 In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12359 @value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12360
12361 @example
12362 bug-gdb@@gnu.org
12363 @end example
12364
12365 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
12366 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
12367 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12368 @samp{bug-gdb}.
12369
12370 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12371 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12372 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12373 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12374 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12375 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12376 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12377 bug reports to the mailing list.
12378
12379 As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12380
12381 @example
12382 @sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12383 Free Software Foundation Inc.
12384 59 Temple Place - Suite 330
12385 Boston, MA 02111-1307
12386 USA
12387 @end example
12388
12389 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12390 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12391 fact or leave it out, state it!
12392
12393 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12394 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12395 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12396 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12397 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12398 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12399 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12400 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12401 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12402
12403 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12404 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12405 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12406 self-contained.
12407
12408 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12409 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12410 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12411 bugs properly.
12412
12413 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12414
12415 @itemize @bullet
12416 @item
12417 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12418 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12419 version}.
12420
12421 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12422 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12423
12424 @item
12425 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12426 version number.
12427
12428 @item
12429 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12430 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
12431
12432 @item
12433 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12434 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12435 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12436 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12437 compilers.
12438
12439 @item
12440 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12441 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12442 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12443 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12444
12445 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12446 and then we might not encounter the bug.
12447
12448 @item
12449 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12450 reproduce the bug.
12451
12452 @item
12453 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12454 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12455
12456 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12457 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12458 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12459 a chance to make a mistake.
12460
12461 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12462 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12463 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12464 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12465 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12466 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12467 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12468 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12469
12470 @item
12471 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12472 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12473 it by context, not by line number.
12474
12475 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12476 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
12477
12478 @end itemize
12479
12480 Here are some things that are not necessary:
12481
12482 @itemize @bullet
12483 @item
12484 A description of the envelope of the bug.
12485
12486 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12487 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12488 changes will not affect it.
12489
12490 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12491 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12492 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12493 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12494
12495 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12496 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12497 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12498 less time, and so on.
12499
12500 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12501 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12502
12503 @item
12504 A patch for the bug.
12505
12506 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12507 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12508 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12509 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12510
12511 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12512 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12513 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12514 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12515
12516 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12517 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12518 help us to understand.
12519
12520 @item
12521 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12522
12523 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12524 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12525 @end itemize
12526
12527 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12528 @c and consists of the two following files:
12529 @c rluser.texinfo
12530 @c inc-hist.texinfo
12531 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12532 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12533 @include rluser.texinfo
12534 @include inc-hist.texinfo
12535
12536
12537 @node Formatting Documentation
12538 @appendix Formatting Documentation
12539
12540 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12541 @cindex reference card
12542 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12543 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12544 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12545 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12546 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12547 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12548
12549 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12550 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12551
12552 @example
12553 make refcard.dvi
12554 @end example
12555
12556 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12557 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12558 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12559 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12560 your @sc{dvi} output program.
12561
12562 @cindex documentation
12563
12564 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12565 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12566 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12567 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12568 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12569 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12570
12571 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12572 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12573 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12574 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12575 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12576 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12577 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12578 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12579
12580 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12581 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12582 @code{makeinfo}.
12583
12584 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12585 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12586 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12587
12588 @example
12589 cd gdb
12590 make gdb.info
12591 @end example
12592
12593 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12594 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12595 Texinfo definitions file.
12596
12597 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12598 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12599 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12600 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12601 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12602 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12603 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12604
12605 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12606 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12607 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12608 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12609 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12610 directory.
12611
12612 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12613 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12614 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12615 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12616
12617 @example
12618 make gdb.dvi
12619 @end example
12620
12621 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
12622
12623 @node Installing GDB
12624 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12625 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12626 @cindex installation
12627
12628 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12629 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12630 build the @code{gdb} program.
12631 @iftex
12632 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12633 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12634 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12635 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12636 @end iftex
12637
12638 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12639 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12640 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12641
12642 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12643 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12644
12645 @table @code
12646 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12647 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12648
12649 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12650 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12651
12652 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12653 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12654
12655 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12656 @sc{gnu} include files
12657
12658 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12659 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12660
12661 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12662 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12663
12664 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12665 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12666
12667 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12668 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12669
12670 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12671 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12672 @end table
12673
12674 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12675 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12676 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12677
12678 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12679 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12680 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12681 argument.
12682
12683 For example:
12684
12685 @example
12686 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12687 ./configure @var{host}
12688 make
12689 @end example
12690
12691 @noindent
12692 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12693 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12694 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12695 correct value by examining your system.)
12696
12697 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12698 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12699 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12700 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12701
12702 @need 750
12703 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12704 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12705 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12706
12707 @example
12708 sh configure @var{host}
12709 @end example
12710
12711 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12712 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12713 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12714 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12715 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12716
12717 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12718 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12719 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12720
12721 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12722 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12723
12724 @example
12725 @group
12726 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12727 ../configure @var{host}
12728 @end group
12729 @end example
12730
12731 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12732 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12733 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12734 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12735 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12736
12737 @menu
12738 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12739 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12740 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12741 @end menu
12742
12743 @node Separate Objdir
12744 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12745
12746 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12747 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12748 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12749 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12750 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12751 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12752 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12753 program specified there.
12754
12755 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12756 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12757 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12758 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12759 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12760 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12761
12762 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12763 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12764
12765 @example
12766 @group
12767 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12768 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12769 cd ../gdb-sun4
12770 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12771 make
12772 @end group
12773 @end example
12774
12775 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12776 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12777 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12778 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12779 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12780 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12781
12782 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12783 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12784 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12785 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12786 You specify a cross-debugging target by
12787 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12788
12789 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12790 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12791 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12792
12793 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12794 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12795 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12796 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12797 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12798
12799 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12800 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12801 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12802 with each other.
12803
12804 @node Config Names
12805 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12806
12807 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12808 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12809 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12810 of information in the following pattern:
12811
12812 @example
12813 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12814 @end example
12815
12816 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12817 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12818 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12819
12820 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12821 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12822 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12823 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12824 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12825 abbreviations---for example:
12826
12827 @smallexample
12828 % sh config.sub i386-linux
12829 i386-pc-linux-gnu
12830 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
12831 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12832 % sh config.sub hp9k700
12833 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12834 % sh config.sub sun4
12835 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12836 % sh config.sub sun3
12837 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12838 % sh config.sub i986v
12839 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12840 @end smallexample
12841
12842 @noindent
12843 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12844 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12845
12846 @node Configure Options
12847 @section @code{configure} options
12848
12849 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12850 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12851 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12852 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12853
12854 @example
12855 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12856 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12857 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12858 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12859 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12860 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12861 @var{host}
12862 @end example
12863
12864 @noindent
12865 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12866 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12867 @samp{--}.
12868
12869 @table @code
12870 @item --help
12871 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12872
12873 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
12874 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12875 @file{@var{dir}}.
12876
12877 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12878 Configure the source to install programs under directory
12879 @file{@var{dir}}.
12880
12881 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12882 @need 2000
12883 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12884 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12885 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12886 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12887 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12888 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12889 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12890 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12891 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12892 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12893 @var{dirname}.
12894
12895 @item --norecursion
12896 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12897 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12898
12899 @item --target=@var{target}
12900 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12901 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12902 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12903
12904 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12905
12906 @item @var{host} @dots{}
12907 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12908
12909 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12910 @end table
12911
12912 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12913 needed for special purposes only.
12914
12915 @node Index
12916 @unnumbered Index
12917
12918 @printindex cp
12919
12920 @tex
12921 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12922 % meantime:
12923 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12924 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12925 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12926 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12927 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12928 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12929 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12930 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12931 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12932 \page\colophon
12933 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12934 @end tex
12935
12936 @c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
12937 @ifinfo
12938 @contents
12939 @end ifinfo
12940 @ifhtml
12941 @contents
12942 @end ifhtml
12943
12944 @bye
This page took 0.298312 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.